annotate man/reftex.texi @ 59536:bf2af98cd2b4

version 4.26
author Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
date Fri, 14 Jan 2005 10:16:38 +0000
parents 6233bef879d8
children 87ebb131f763
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2 @c %**start of header
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3 @setfilename reftex
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4 @settitle RefTeX User Manual
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5 @dircategory Emacs
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
6 @direntry
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
7 * RefTeX: (reftex). Emacs support for LaTeX cross-references and citations.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
8 @end direntry
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
9 @synindex ky cp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
10 @syncodeindex vr cp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
11 @syncodeindex fn cp
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
12
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
13 @c Version and Contact Info
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
14 @set VERSION 4.24
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
15 @set EDITION 4.24
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
16 @set DATE August 2004
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
17 @set AUCTEXSITE @uref{http://www.nongnu.org/auctex/,AUCTeX distribution site}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
18 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/,maintainers webpage}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
19 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
20 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{dominik@@science.uva.nl}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
21 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:dominik@@science.uva.nl,contact the maintainer}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
22 @set XEMACSFTP @uref{ftp://ftp.xemacs.org/pub/xemacs/packages/,XEmacs ftp site}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
23 @c %**end of header
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
24 @finalout
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
25
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
26 @c Macro definitions
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
27
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
28 @c Subheadings inside a table. Need a difference between info and the rest.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
29 @macro tablesubheading{text}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
30 @ifinfo
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
31 @subsubheading \text\
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
32 @end ifinfo
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
33 @ifnotinfo
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
34 @item @b{\text\}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
35 @end ifnotinfo
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
36 @end macro
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
37
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
38 @ifinfo
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
39 This file documents @b{Ref@TeX{}}, a package to do labels, references,
47737
0a70200bde27 use @copying instead of @ifinfo.
Karl Berry <karl@gnu.org>
parents: 47050
diff changeset
40 citations and indices for LaTeX documents with Emacs.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
41
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
42 This is edition @value{EDITION} of the @b{Ref@TeX{}} User Manual for
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
43 @b{Ref@TeX{}} @value{VERSION}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
44
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
45 Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
46
37404
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
47 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
48 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
49 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
50 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
51 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
52 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
53 License'' in the Emacs manual.
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
54
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
55 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
56 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
57 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
58
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
59 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
60 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
61 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
730f77edf073 Use GNU Free Documentation License.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37038
diff changeset
62 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
63 @end ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
64
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
65 @titlepage
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
66 @title Ref@TeX{} User Manual
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
67 @subtitle Support for LaTeX labels, references, citations and index entries with GNU Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
68 @subtitle Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
69
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
70 @author by Carsten Dominik
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
71 @page
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
72 Copyright @copyright{} 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
73
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
74 @sp 2
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
75 This is edition @value{EDITION} of the @cite{Ref@TeX{} User Manual} for
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
76 @b{Ref@TeX{}} version @value{VERSION}, @value{DATE}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
77
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
78 @sp 2
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
79
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
80 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
81 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
82 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
83 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
84 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
85 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
86 License'' in the Emacs manual.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
87
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
88 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
89 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
90 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
91
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
92 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
93 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
94 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
95 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
96 @end titlepage
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
97 @page
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
98
29772
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
99 @ifnottex
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
100 @node Top,,,(dir)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
101
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
102 @b{Ref@TeX{}} is a package for managing Labels, References,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
103 Citations and index entries with GNU Emacs.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
104
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
105 Don't be discouraged by the size of this manual, which covers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
106 @b{Ref@TeX{}} in great depth. All you need to know to use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
107 @b{Ref@TeX{}} can be summarized on two pages (@pxref{RefTeX in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
108 Nutshell}). You can go back later to other parts of this document when
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
109 needed.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
110
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
111 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
112 * Introduction:: Quick-Start information.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
113
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
114 * Table of Contents:: A Tool to move around quickly.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
115 * Labels and References:: Creating and referencing labels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
116 * Citations:: Creating Citations.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
117 * Index Support:: Creating and Checking Index Entries.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
118 * Viewing Cross-References:: Who references or cites what?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
119
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
120 * RefTeXs Menu:: The Ref menu in the menubar.
39267
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
121 * Key Bindings:: The default key bindings.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
122 * Faces:: Fontification of RefTeX's buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
123 * Multifile Documents:: Document spread over many files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
124 * Language Support:: How to support other languages.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
125 * Finding Files:: Included TeX files and BibTeX .bib files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
126 * AUCTeX:: Cooperation with AUCTeX.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
127 * Optimizations:: When RefTeX is too slow.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
128 * Problems and Work-Arounds:: First Aid.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
129 * Imprint:: Author, Web-site, Thanks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
130
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
131 * Commands:: Which are the available commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
132 * Options:: How to extend and configure RefTeX.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
133 * Keymaps and Hooks:: For customization.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
134 * Changes:: A List of recent changes to RefTeX.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
135
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
136 The Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
137
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
138 * Index:: The full index.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
139
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
140 @detailmenu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
141
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
142 Introduction
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
143
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
144 * Installation:: How to install and activate RefTeX.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
145 * RefTeX in a Nutshell:: A brief summary and quick guide.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
146
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
147 Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
148
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
149 * Creating Labels::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
150 * Referencing Labels::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
151 * Builtin Label Environments:: The environments RefTeX knows about.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
152 * Defining Label Environments:: ... and environments it doesn't.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
153 * Reference Info:: View the label corresponding to a \ref.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
154 * xr (LaTeX package):: References to external documents.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
155 * varioref (LaTeX package):: How to create \vref instead of \ref.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
156 * fancyref (LaTeX package):: How to create \fref instead of \ref.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
157
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
158 Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
159
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
160 * Theorem and Axiom:: Defined with @code{\newenvironment}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
161 * Quick Equation:: When a macro sets the label type.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
162 * Figure Wrapper:: When a macro argument is a label.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
163 * Adding Magic Words:: Other words for other languages.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
164 * Using \eqref:: How to switch to this AMS-LaTeX macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
165 * Non-Standard Environments:: Environments without \begin and \end
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
166 * Putting it Together:: How to combine many entries.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
167
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
168 Citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
169
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
170 * Creating Citations:: How to create them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
171 * Citation Styles:: Natbib, Harvard, Chicago and Co.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
172 * Citation Info:: View the corresponding database entry.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
173 * Chapterbib and Bibunits:: Multiple bibliographies in a Document.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
174 * Citations Outside LaTeX:: How to make citations in Emails etc.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
175 * BibTeX Database Subsets:: Extract parts of a big database.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
176
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
177 Index Support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
178
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
179 * Creating Index Entries:: Macros and completion of entries.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
180 * The Index Phrases File:: A special file for global indexing.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
181 * Displaying and Editing the Index:: The index editor.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
182 * Builtin Index Macros:: The index macros RefTeX knows about.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
183 * Defining Index Macros:: ... and macros it doesn't.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
184
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
185 The Index Phrases File
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
186
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
187 * Collecting Phrases:: Collecting from document or external.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
188 * Consistency Checks:: Check for duplicates etc.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
189 * Global Indexing:: The interactive indexing process.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
190
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
191 AUCTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
192
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
193 * AUCTeX-RefTeX Interface:: How both packages work together
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
194 * Style Files:: AUCTeX's style files can support RefTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
195 * Bib-Cite:: Hypertext reading of a document
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
196
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
197 Options, Keymaps, Hooks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
198
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
199 * Options (Table of Contents)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
200 * Options (Defining Label Environments)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
201 * Options (Creating Labels)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
202 * Options (Referencing Labels)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
203 * Options (Creating Citations)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
204 * Options (Index Support)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
205 * Options (Viewing Cross-References)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
206 * Options (Finding Files)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
207 * Options (Optimizations)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
208 * Options (Fontification)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
209 * Options (Misc)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
210
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
211 @end detailmenu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
212 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
213
29772
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
214 @end ifnottex
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
215
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
216 @node Introduction, Table of Contents, , Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
217 @chapter Introduction
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
218 @cindex Introduction
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
219
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
220 @b{Ref@TeX{}} is a specialized package for support of labels,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
221 references, citations, and the index in LaTeX. @b{Ref@TeX{}} wraps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
222 itself round 4 LaTeX macros: @code{\label}, @code{\ref}, @code{\cite},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
223 and @code{\index}. Using these macros usually requires looking up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
224 different parts of the document and searching through BibTeX database
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
225 files. @b{Ref@TeX{}} automates these time--consuming tasks almost
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
226 entirely. It also provides functions to display the structure of a
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
227 document and to move around in this structure quickly.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
228
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
229 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
230 Don't be discouraged by the size of this manual, which covers @b{Ref@TeX{}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
231 in great depth. All you need to know to use @b{Ref@TeX{}} can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
232 summarized on two pages (@pxref{RefTeX in a Nutshell}). You can go
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
233 back later to other parts of this document when needed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
234 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
235
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
236 @xref{Imprint}, for information about who to contact for help, bug
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
237 reports or suggestions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
238
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
239 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
240 * Installation:: How to install and activate RefTeX.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
241 * RefTeX in a Nutshell:: A brief summary and quick guide.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
242 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
243
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
244 @node Installation, RefTeX in a Nutshell, , Introduction
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
245 @section Installation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
246 @cindex Installation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
247
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
248 @b{Ref@TeX{}} is bundled and pre--installed with Emacs since version
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
249 20.2. It was also bundled and pre--installed with XEmacs 19.16--20.x.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
250 XEmacs 21.x users want to install the corresponding plug-in package
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
251 which is available from the @value{XEMACSFTP}. See the XEmacs 21.x
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
252 documentation on package installation for details.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
253
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
254 Users of earlier Emacs distributions (including Emacs 19) can get a copy
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
255 of the @b{Ref@TeX{}} distribution from the maintainers web-page.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
256 @xref{Imprint}, for more information.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
257
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
258 @section Environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
259 @cindex Finding files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
260 @cindex BibTeX database files, not found
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
261 @cindex TeX files, not found
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
262 @cindex @code{TEXINPUTS}, environment variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
263 @cindex @code{BIBINPUTS}, environment variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
264
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
265 @b{Ref@TeX{}} needs to access all files which are part of a multifile
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
266 document, and the BibTeX database files requested by the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
267 @code{\bibliography} command. To find these files, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
268 require a search path, i.e. a list of directories to check. Normally
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
269 this list is stored in the environment variables @code{TEXINPUTS} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
270 @code{BIBINPUTS} which are also used by @b{Ref@TeX{}}. However, on some
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
271 systems these variables do not contain the full search path. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
272 @b{Ref@TeX{}} does not work for you because it cannot find some files,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
273 read @ref{Finding Files}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
274
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
275 @section Entering @b{Ref@TeX{}} Mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
276
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
277 @findex turn-on-reftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
278 @findex reftex-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
279 @vindex LaTeX-mode-hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
280 @vindex latex-mode-hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
281 To turn @b{Ref@TeX{}} Mode on and off in a particular buffer, use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
282 @kbd{M-x reftex-mode}. To turn on @b{Ref@TeX{}} Mode for all LaTeX
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
283 files, add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
284
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
285 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
286 (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook 'turn-on-reftex) ; with AUCTeX LaTeX mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
287 (add-hook 'latex-mode-hook 'turn-on-reftex) ; with Emacs latex mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
288 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
289
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
290 @page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
291 @node RefTeX in a Nutshell, , Installation, Introduction
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
292 @section @b{Ref@TeX{}} in a Nutshell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
293 @cindex Quick-Start
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
294 @cindex Getting Started
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
295 @cindex RefTeX in a Nutshell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
296 @cindex Nutshell, RefTeX in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
297
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
298 @enumerate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
299 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
300 @b{Table of Contents}@* Typing @kbd{C-c =} (@code{reftex-toc}) will show
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
301 a table of contents of the document. This buffer can display sections,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
302 labels and index entries defined in the document. From the buffer, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
303 can jump quickly to every part of your document. Press @kbd{?} to get
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
304 help.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
305
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
306 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
307 @b{Labels and References}@* @b{Ref@TeX{}} helps to create unique labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
308 and to find the correct key for references quickly. It distinguishes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
309 labels for different environments, knows about all standard
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
310 environments (and many others), and can be configured to recognize any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
311 additional labeled environments you have defined yourself (variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
312 @code{reftex-label-alist}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
313
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
314 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
315 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
316 @b{Creating Labels}@*
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
317 Type @kbd{C-c (} (@code{reftex-label}) to insert a label at point.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
318 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will either
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
319 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
320 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
321 derive a label from context (default for section labels)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
322 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
323 prompt for a label string (default for figures and tables) or
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
324 @item
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
325 insert a simple label made of a prefix and a number (all other
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
326 environments)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
327 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
328 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
329 Which labels are created how is configurable with the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
330 @code{reftex-insert-label-flags}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
331
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
332 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
333 @b{Referencing Labels}@* To make a reference, type @kbd{C-c )}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
334 (@code{reftex-reference}). This shows an outline of the document with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
335 all labels of a certain type (figure, equation,...) and some label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
336 context. Selecting a label inserts a @code{\ref@{@var{label}@}} macro
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
337 into the original buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
338 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
339
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
340 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
341 @b{Citations}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
342 Typing @kbd{C-c [} (@code{reftex-citation}) will let you specify a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
343 regular expression to search in current BibTeX database files (as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
344 specified in the @code{\bibliography} command) and pull out a list of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
345 matches for you to choose from. The list is @emph{formatted} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
346 sorted. The selected article is referenced as @samp{\cite@{@var{key}@}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
347 (see the variable @code{reftex-cite-format} if you want to insert
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
348 different macros).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
349
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
350 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
351 @b{Index Support}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
352 @b{Ref@TeX{}} helps to enter index entries. It also compiles all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
353 entries into an alphabetically sorted @file{*Index*} buffer which you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
354 can use to check and edit the entries. @b{Ref@TeX{}} knows about the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
355 standard index macros and can be configured to recognize any additional
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
356 macros you have defined (@code{reftex-index-macros}). Multiple indices
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
357 are supported.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
358
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
359 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
360 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
361 @b{Creating Index Entries}@*
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
362 To index the current selection or the word at point, type @kbd{C-c /}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
363 (@code{reftex-index-selection-or-word}). The default macro
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
364 @code{reftex-index-default-macro} will be used. For a more complex entry
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
365 type @kbd{C-c <} (@code{reftex-index}), select any of the index macros
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
366 and enter the arguments with completion.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
367
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
368 @item
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
369 @b{The Index Phrases File (Delayed Indexing)}@*
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
370 Type @kbd{C-c \} (@code{reftex-index-phrase-selection-or-word}) to add
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
371 the current word or selection to a special @emph{index phrase file}.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
372 @b{Ref@TeX{}} can later search the document for occurrences of these
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
373 phrases and let you interactively index the matches.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
374
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
375 @item
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
376 @b{Displaying and Editing the Index}@*
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
377 To display the compiled index in a special buffer, type @kbd{C-c >}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
378 (@code{reftex-display-index}). From that buffer you can check and edit
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
379 all entries.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
380 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
381
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
382 @page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
383 @item @b{Viewing Cross-References}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
384 When point is on the @var{key} argument of a cross--referencing macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
385 (@code{\label}, @code{\ref}, @code{\cite}, @code{\bibitem},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
386 @code{\index}, and variations) or inside a BibTeX database entry, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
387 can press @kbd{C-c &} (@code{reftex-view-crossref}) to display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
388 corresponding locations in the document and associated BibTeX database
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
389 files. @*
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
390 When the enclosing macro is @code{\cite} or @code{\ref} and no other
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
391 message occupies the echo area, information about the citation or label
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
392 will automatically be displayed in the echo area.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
393
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
394 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
395 @b{Multifile Documents}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
396 Multifile Documents are fully supported. The included files must have a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
397 file variable @code{TeX-master} or @code{tex-main-file} pointing to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
398 master file. @b{Ref@TeX{}} provides cross-referencing information from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
399 all parts of the document, and across document borders
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
400 (@file{xr.sty}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
401
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
402 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
403 @b{Document Parsing}@* @b{Ref@TeX{}} needs to parse the document in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
404 order to find labels and other information. It does it automatically
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
405 once and updates its list internally when @code{reftex-label} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
406 @code{reftex-index} are used. To enforce reparsing, call any of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
407 commands described above with a raw @kbd{C-u} prefix, or press the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
408 @kbd{r} key in the label selection buffer, the table of contents
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
409 buffer, or the index buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
410
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
411 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
412 @b{AUCTeX} @* If your major LaTeX mode is AUCTeX, @b{Ref@TeX{}} can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
413 cooperate with it (see variable @code{reftex-plug-into-AUCTeX}). AUCTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
414 contains style files which trigger appropriate settings in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
415 @b{Ref@TeX{}}, so that for many of the popular LaTeX packages no
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
416 additional customizations will be necessary.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
417
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
418 @item
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
419 @b{Useful Settings}@*
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
420 To integrate RefTeX with AUCTeX, use
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
421 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
422 (setq reftex-plug-into-AUCTeX t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
423 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
424
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
425 To make your own LaTeX macro definitions known to @b{Ref@TeX{}},
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
426 customize the variables
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
427 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
428 @code{reftex-label-alist} @r{(for label macros/environments)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
429 @code{reftex-section-levels} @r{(for sectioning commands)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
430 @code{reftex-cite-format} @r{(for @code{\cite}-like macros)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
431 @code{reftex-index-macros} @r{(for @code{\index}-like macros)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
432 @code{reftex-index-default-macro} @r{(to set the default macro)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
433 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
434 If you have a large number of macros defined, you may want to write
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
435 an AUCTeX style file to support them with both AUCTeX and
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
436 @b{Ref@TeX{}}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
437
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
438 @item @b{Where Next?}@* Go ahead and use @b{Ref@TeX{}}. Use its menus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
439 until you have picked up the key bindings. For an overview of what you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
440 can do in each of the different special buffers, press @kbd{?}. Read
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
441 the manual if you get stuck, of if you are curious what else might be
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
442 available. The first part of the manual explains in
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
443 a tutorial way how to use and customize @b{Ref@TeX{}}. The second
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
444 part is a command and variable reference.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
445 @end enumerate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
446
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
447 @node Table of Contents, Labels and References, Introduction, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
448 @chapter Table of Contents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
449 @cindex @file{*toc*} buffer
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
450 @cindex Structure editing
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
451 @cindex Table of contents buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
452 @findex reftex-toc
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
453 @kindex C-c =
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
454
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
455 Pressing the keys @kbd{C-c =} pops up a buffer showing the table of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
456 contents of the document. By default, this @file{*toc*} buffer shows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
457 only the sections of a document. Using the @kbd{l} and @kbd{i} keys you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
458 can display all labels and index entries defined in the document as
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
459 well.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
460
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
461 With the cursor in any of the lines denoting a location in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
462 document, simple key strokes will display the corresponding part in
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
463 another window, jump to that location, or perform other actions.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
464
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
465 @kindex ?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
466 Here is a list of special commands in the @file{*toc*} buffer. A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
467 summary of this information is always available by pressing
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
468 @kbd{?}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
469
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
470 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
471
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
472 @tablesubheading{General}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
473 @item ?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
474 Display a summary of commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
475
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
476 @item 0-9, -
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
477 Prefix argument.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
478
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
479 @tablesubheading{Moving around}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
480 @item n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
481 Goto next entry in the table of context.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
482
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
483 @item p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
484 Goto previous entry in the table of context.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
485
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
486 @item C-c C-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
487 Goto next section heading. Useful when many labels and index entries
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
488 separate section headings.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
489
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
490 @item C-c C-p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
491 Goto previous section heading.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
492
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
493 @item N z
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
494 Jump to section N, using the prefix arg. For example, @kbd{3 z} jumps
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
495 to section 3.
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
496
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
497 @tablesubheading{Access to document locations}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
498 @item @key{SPC}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
499 Show the corresponding location in another window. This command does
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
500 @emph{not} select that other window.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
501
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
502 @item @key{TAB}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
503 Goto the location in another window.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
504
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
505 @item @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
506 Go to the location and hide the @file{*toc*} buffer. This will restore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
507 the window configuration before @code{reftex-toc} (@kbd{C-c =}) was
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
508 called.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
509
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
510 @item mouse-2
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
511 @vindex reftex-highlight-selection
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
512 Clicking with mouse button 2 on a line has the same effect as @key{RET}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
513 See also variable @code{reftex-highlight-selection}, @ref{Options
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
514 (Fontification)}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
515
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
516 @item f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
517 @vindex reftex-toc-follow-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
518 @vindex reftex-revisit-to-follow
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
519 Toggle follow mode. When follow mode is active, the other window will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
520 always show the location corresponding to the line at point in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
521 @file{*toc*} buffer. This is similar to pressing @key{SPC} after each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
522 cursor motion. The default for this flag can be set with the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
523 @code{reftex-toc-follow-mode}. Note that only context in files already
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
524 visited is shown. @b{Ref@TeX{}} will not visit a file just for follow
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
525 mode. See, however, the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
526 @code{reftex-revisit-to-follow}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
527
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
528 @item .
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
529 Show calling point in another window. This is the point from where
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
530 @code{reftex-toc} was last called.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
531
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
532 @page
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
533 @tablesubheading{Promotion and Demotion}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
534
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
535 @item <
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
536 Promote the current section. This will convert @code{\section} to
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
537 @code{\chapter}, @code{\subsection} to @code{\section} etc. If there is
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
538 an active region, all sections in the region will be promoted, including
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
539 the one at point. To avoid mistakes, @b{Ref@TeX{}} requires a fresh
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
540 document scan before executing this command - if necessary, it will
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
541 automatically do this scan and ask the user to repeat the promotion
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
542 command.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
543
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
544 @item >
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
545 Demote the current section. This is the opposite of promotion. It will
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
546 convert @code{\chapter} to @code{\section} etc. If there is an active
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
547 region, all sections in the region will be demoted, including the one at
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
548 point.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
549
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
550 @item M-%
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
551 Rename the label at point. While generally not recommended, this can be
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
552 useful when a package like @file{fancyref} is used where the label
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
553 prefix determines the wording of a reference. After a
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
554 promotion/demotion it may be necessary to change a few labels from
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
555 @samp{sec:xyz} to @samp{cha:xyz} or vice versa. This command can be
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
556 used to do this - it launches a query replace to rename the definition
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
557 and all references of a label.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
558
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
559 @tablesubheading{Exiting}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
560 @item q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
561 Hide the @file{*toc*} buffer, return to the position where
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
562 @code{reftex-toc} was last called.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
563
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
564 @item k
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
565 Kill the @file{*toc*} buffer, return to the position where
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
566 @code{reftex-toc} was last called.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
567
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
568 @item C-c >
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
569 Switch to the @file{*Index*} buffer of this document. With prefix
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
570 @samp{2}, restrict the index to the section at point in the @file{*toc*}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
571 buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
572
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
573 @tablesubheading{Controlling what gets displayed}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
574
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
575 @item t
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
576 @vindex reftex-toc-max-level
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
577 Change the maximum level of toc entries displayed in the @file{*toc*}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
578 buffer. Without prefix arg, all levels will be included. With prefix
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
579 arg (e.g @kbd{3 t}), ignore all toc entries with level greater than
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
580 @var{arg} (3 in this case). Chapters are level 1, sections are level 2.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
581 The mode line @samp{T<>} indicator shows the current value. The default
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
582 depth can be configured with the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
583 @code{reftex-toc-max-level}.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
584
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
585 @item F
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
586 @vindex reftex-toc-include-file-boundaries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
587 Toggle the display of the file borders of a multifile document in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
588 @file{*toc*} buffer. The default for this flag can be set with the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
589 variable @code{reftex-toc-include-file-boundaries}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
590
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
591 @item l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
592 @vindex reftex-toc-include-labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
593 Toggle the display of labels in the @file{*toc*} buffer. The default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
594 for this flag can be set with the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
595 @code{reftex-toc-include-labels}. When called with a prefix argument,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
596 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will prompt for a label type and include only labels of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
597 the selected type in the @file{*toc*} buffer. The mode line @samp{L<>}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
598 indicator shows which labels are included.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
599
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
600 @item i
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
601 @vindex reftex-toc-include-index-entries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
602 Toggle the display of index entries in the @file{*toc*} buffer. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
603 default for this flag can be set with the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
604 @code{reftex-toc-include-index-entries}. When called with a prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
605 argument, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will prompt for a specific index and include
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
606 only entries in the selected index in the @file{*toc*} buffer. The mode
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
607 line @samp{I<>} indicator shows which index is used.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
608
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
609 @item c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
610 @vindex reftex-toc-include-context
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
611 Toggle the display of label and index context in the @file{*toc*}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
612 buffer. The default for this flag can be set with the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
613 @code{reftex-toc-include-context}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
614
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
615 @tablesubheading{Updating the buffer}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
616
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
617 @item g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
618 Rebuild the @file{*toc*} buffer. This does @emph{not} rescan the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
619 document.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
620
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
621 @item r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
622 @vindex reftex-enable-partial-scans
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
623 Reparse the LaTeX document and rebuild the @file{*toc*} buffer. When
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
624 @code{reftex-enable-partial-scans} is non-nil, rescan only the file this
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
625 location is defined in, not the entire document.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
626
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
627 @item C-u r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
628 Reparse the @emph{entire} LaTeX document and rebuild the @file{*toc*}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
629 buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
630
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
631 @item x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
632 Switch to the @file{*toc*} buffer of an external document. When the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
633 current document is using the @code{xr} package (@pxref{xr (LaTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
634 package)}), @b{Ref@TeX{}} will switch to one of the external
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
635 documents.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
636
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
637
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
638 @tablesubheading{Automatic recentering}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
639
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
640 @item d
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
641 Toggle the display of a dedicated frame displaying just the @file{*toc*}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
642 buffer. Follow mode and visiting locations will not work that frame,
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
643 but automatic recentering will make this frame always show your current
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
644 editing location in the document (see below).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
645
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
646 @item a
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
647 Toggle the automatic recentering of the @file{*toc*} buffer. When this
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
648 option is on, moving around in the document will cause the @file{*toc*}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
649 to always highlight the current section. By default, this option is
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
650 active while the dedicated @file{*TOC*} frame exists. See also the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
651 variable @code{reftex-auto-recenter-toc}.
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
652
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
653 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
654
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
655 @vindex reftex-toc-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
656 In order to define additional commands for the @file{*toc*} buffer, the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
657 keymap @code{reftex-toc-map} may be used.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
658
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
659 @findex reftex-toc-recenter
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
660 @vindex reftex-auto-recenter-toc
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
661 @vindex reftex-idle-time
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
662 @cindex @file{*toc*} buffer, recentering
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
663 @cindex Table of contents buffer, recentering
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
664 @kindex C-c -
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
665 If you call @code{reftex-toc} while the @file{*toc*} buffer already
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
666 exists, the cursor will immediately jump to the right place, i.e. the
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
667 section from which @code{reftex-toc} was called will be highlighted.
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
668 The command @kbd{C-c -} (@code{reftex-toc-recenter}) will only redisplay
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
669 the @file{*toc*} buffer and highlight the correct line without actually
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
670 selecting the @file{*toc*} window. This can be useful to quickly find
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
671 out where in the document you currently are. You can also automate this
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
672 by asking RefTeX to keep track of your current editing position in the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
673 TOC. The TOC window will then be updated whenever you stop typing for
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
674 more than @code{reftex-idle-time} seconds. By default this works only
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
675 with the dedicated @file{*TOC*} frame. But you can also force automatic
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
676 recentering of the TOC window on the current frame with
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
677 @lisp
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
678 (setq reftex-auto-recenter-toc t)
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
679 @end lisp
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
680
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
681
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
682 @cindex Sectioning commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
683 @cindex KOMA-Script, LaTeX classes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
684 @cindex LaTeX classes, KOMA-Script
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
685 @cindex TOC entries for environments
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
686 @vindex reftex-section-levels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
687 The section macros recognized by @b{Ref@TeX{}} are all LaTeX section
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
688 macros (from @code{\part} to @code{\subsubparagraph}) and the commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
689 @code{\addchap} and @code{\addsec} from the KOMA-Script classes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
690 Additional macros can be configured with the variable
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
691 @code{reftex-section-levels}. It is also possible to add certain LaTeX
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
692 environments to the table of contents. This is probably only useful for
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
693 theorem-like environments. @xref{Defining Label Environments}, for an
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
694 example.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
695
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
696 @node Labels and References, Citations, Table of Contents, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
697 @chapter Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
698 @cindex Labels in LaTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
699 @cindex References in LaTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
700 @cindex Label category
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
701 @cindex Label environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
702 @cindex @code{\label}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
703
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
704 LaTeX provides a powerful mechanism to deal with cross--references in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
705 document. When writing a document, any part of it can be marked with a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
706 label, like @samp{\label@{mark@}}. LaTeX records the current value of a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
707 certain counter when a label is defined. Later references to this label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
708 (like @samp{\ref@{mark@}}) will produce the recorded value of the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
709 counter.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
710
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
711 Labels can be used to mark sections, figures, tables, equations,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
712 footnotes, items in enumerate lists etc. LaTeX is context sensitive in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
713 doing this: A label defined in a figure environment automatically
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
714 records the figure counter, not the section counter.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
715
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
716 Several different environments can share a common counter and therefore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
717 a common label category. E.g. labels in both @code{equation} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
718 @code{eqnarray} environments record the value of the same counter - the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
719 equation counter.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
720
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
721 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
722 * Creating Labels::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
723 * Referencing Labels::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
724 * Builtin Label Environments:: The environments RefTeX knows about.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
725 * Defining Label Environments:: ... and environments it doesn't.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
726 * Reference Info:: View the label corresponding to a \ref.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
727 * xr (LaTeX package):: References to external documents.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
728 * varioref (LaTeX package):: How to create \vref instead of \ref.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
729 * fancyref (LaTeX package):: How to create \fref instead of \ref.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
730 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
731
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
732 @node Creating Labels, Referencing Labels, , Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
733 @section Creating Labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
734 @cindex Creating labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
735 @cindex Labels, creating
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
736 @cindex Labels, deriving from context
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
737 @kindex C-c (
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
738 @findex reftex-label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
739
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
740 In order to create a label in a LaTeX document, press @kbd{C-c (}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
741 (@code{reftex-label}). Just like LaTeX, @b{Ref@TeX{}} is context sensitive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
742 and will figure out the environment it currently is in and adapt the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
743 label to that environment. A label usually consists of a short prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
744 indicating the type of the label and a unique mark. @b{Ref@TeX{}} has
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
745 3 different modes to create this mark.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
746
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
747 @enumerate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
748 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
749 @vindex reftex-translate-to-ascii-function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
750 @vindex reftex-derive-label-parameters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
751 @vindex reftex-label-illegal-re
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
752 @vindex reftex-abbrev-parameters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
753 A label can be derived from context. This means, @b{Ref@TeX{}} takes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
754 the context of the label definition and constructs a label from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
755 that@footnote{Note that the context may contain constructs which are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
756 illegal in labels. @b{Ref@TeX{}} will therefore strip the accent from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
757 accented Latin-1 characters and remove everything else which is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
758 legal in labels. This mechanism is safe, but may not be satisfactory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
759 for non-western languages. Check the following variables if you need to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
760 change things: @code{reftex-translate-to-ascii-function},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
761 @code{reftex-derive-label-parameters}, @code{reftex-label-illegal-re},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
762 @code{reftex-abbrev-parameters}.}. This works best for section labels,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
763 where the section heading is used to construct a label. In fact,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
764 @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s default settings use this method only for section
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
765 labels. You will be asked to confirm the derived label, or edit
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
766 it.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
767
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
768 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
769 We may also use a simple unique number to identify a label. This is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
770 mostly useful for labels where it is difficult to come up with a very
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
771 good descriptive name. @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s default settings use this method
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
772 for equations, enumerate items and footnotes. The author of @b{Ref@TeX{}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
773 tends to write documents with many equations and finds it impossible
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
774 to come up with good names for each of them. These simple labels are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
775 inserted without query, and are therefore very fast. Good descriptive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
776 names are not really necessary as @b{Ref@TeX{}} will provide context to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
777 reference a label (@pxref{Referencing Labels}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
778
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
779 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
780 The third method is to ask the user for a label. This is most
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
781 useful for things which are easy to describe briefly and do not turn up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
782 too frequently in a document. @b{Ref@TeX{}} uses this for figures and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
783 tables. Of course, one can enter the label directly by typing the full
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
784 @samp{\label@{mark@}}. The advantage of using @code{reftex-label}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
785 anyway is that @b{Ref@TeX{}} will know that a new label has been defined.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
786 It will then not be necessary to rescan the document in order to access
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
787 this label later.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
788 @end enumerate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
789
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
790 @vindex reftex-insert-label-flags
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
791 If you want to change the way certain labels are created, check out the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
792 variable @code{reftex-insert-label-flags} (@pxref{Options (Creating
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
793 Labels)}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
794
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
795 If you are using AUCTeX to write your LaTeX documents, you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
796 set it up to delegate the creation of labels to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
797 @b{Ref@TeX{}}. @xref{AUCTeX}, for more information.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
798
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
799 @node Referencing Labels, Builtin Label Environments, Creating Labels, Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
800 @section Referencing Labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
801 @cindex Referencing labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
802 @cindex Labels, referencing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
803 @cindex Selection buffer, labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
804 @cindex Selection process
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
805 @cindex @code{\ref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
806 @kindex C-c )
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
807 @findex reftex-reference
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
808
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
809 @vindex reftex-trust-label-prefix
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
810 @b{Ref@TeX{}} scans the document in order to find all labels. To make
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
811 referencing labels easier, it assigns to each label a category, the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
812 @emph{label type} (for example section, table, figure, equation, etc.).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
813 In order to determine the label type, RefTeX parses around each label
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
814 to see in what kind of environments it is located. You can speed up
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
815 the parsing by using type-specific prefixes for labels and configuring
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
816 the variable @code{reftex-trust-label-prefix}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
817
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
818 Referencing Labels is really at the heart of @b{Ref@TeX{}}. Press @kbd{C-c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
819 )} in order to reference a label (reftex-reference). This will start a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
820 selection process and finally insert the complete @samp{\ref@{label@}}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
821 into the buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
822
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
823 First, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will determine the label category which is required.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
824 Often that can be figured out from context. For example, if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
825 write @samp{As shown in eq.} and the press @kbd{C-c )}, @b{Ref@TeX{}} knows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
826 that an equation label is going to be referenced. If it cannot figure
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
827 out what label category is needed, it will query for one.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
828
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
829 You will then be presented with a label selection menu. This is a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
830 special buffer which contains an outline of the document along with all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
831 labels of the given label category. In addition, next to the label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
832 there will be one line of context of the label definition, which is some
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
833 text in the buffer near the label definition. Usually this is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
834 sufficient to identify the label. If you are unsure about a certain
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
835 label, pressing @key{SPC} will show the label definition point in
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
836 another window.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
837
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
838 In order to reference a label, move to cursor to the correct label and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
839 press @key{RET}. You can also reference several labels with a single
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
840 call to @code{reftex-reference} by marking entries with the @kbd{m}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
841 key (see below).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
842
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
843 @kindex ?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
844 Here is a list of special commands in the selection buffer. A summary
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
845 of this information is always available from the selection process by
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
846 pressing @kbd{?}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
847
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
848
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
849
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
850 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
851 @tablesubheading{General}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
852 @item ?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
853 Show a summary of available commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
854
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
855 @item 0-9,-
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
856 Prefix argument.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
857
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
858 @tablesubheading{Moving around}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
859 @item n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
860 Go to next label.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
861
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
862 @item p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
863 Go to previous label.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
864
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
865 @item b
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
866 Jump back to the position where you last left the selection buffer.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
867 Normally this should get you back to the last referenced label.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
868
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
869 @item C-c C-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
870 Goto next section heading.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
871
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
872 @item C-c C-p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
873 Goto previous section heading.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
874
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
875 @item N z
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
876 Jump to section N, using the prefix arg. For example @kbd{3 z} jumps to
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
877 section 3.
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
878
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
879 @tablesubheading{Displaying Context}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
880 @item @key{SPC}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
881 Show the surroundings of the definition of the current label in another
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
882 window. See also the @kbd{f} key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
883
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
884 @item f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
885 @vindex reftex-revisit-to-follow
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
886 Toggle follow mode. When follow mode is active, the other window will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
887 always display the full context of the current label. This is similar
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
888 to pressing @key{SPC} after each cursor motion. Note that only context
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
889 in files already visited is shown. @b{RefTeX} will not visit a file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
890 just for follow mode. See, however, the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
891 @code{reftex-revisit-to-follow}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
892
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
893 @item .
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
894 Show insertion point in another window. This is the point from where you
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
895 called @code{reftex-reference}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
896
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
897 @tablesubheading{Selecting a label and creating the reference}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
898 @item @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
899 Insert a reference to the label at point into the buffer from which the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
900 selection process was started. When entries have been marked, @key{RET}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
901 references all marked labels.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
902
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
903 @item mouse-2
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
904 @vindex reftex-highlight-selection
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
905 Clicking with mouse button 2 on a label will accept it like @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
906 would. See also variable @code{reftex-highlight-selection}, @ref{Options
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
907 (Misc)}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
908
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
909 @vindex reftex-multiref-punctuation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
910 @item m - + ,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
911 Mark the current entry. When several entries have been marked, pressing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
912 @kbd{RET} will accept all of them and place them into several
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
913 @code{\ref} macros. The special markers @samp{,-+} also store a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
914 separator to be inserted before the corresponding reference. So marking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
915 six entries with the keys @samp{m , , - , +} will give a reference list
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
916 like this (see the variable @code{reftex-multiref-punctuation})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
917 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
918 In eqs. (1), (2), (3)--(4), (5) and (6)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
919 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
920
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
921 @item u
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
922 Unmark a marked entry.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
923
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
924 @c FIXME: Do we need `A' as well for consistency?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
925 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{saferef}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
926 @cindex @code{saferef}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
927 @item a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
928 Accept the marked entries and put all labels as a comma-separated list
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
929 into one @emph{single} @code{\ref} macro. Some packages like
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
930 @file{saferef.sty} support multiple references in this way.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
931
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
932 @item l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
933 Use the last referenced label(s) again. This is equivalent to moving to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
934 that label and pressing @key{RET}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
935
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
936 @item @key{TAB}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
937 Enter a label with completion. This may also be a label which does not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
938 yet exist in the document.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
939
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
940 @item v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
941 @cindex @code{varioref}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
942 @cindex @code{\vref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
943 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{varioref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
944 Toggle between @code{\ref} and @code{\vref} macro for references. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
945 @code{\vref} macro is defined in the @code{varioref} LaTeX package.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
946 With this key you can force @b{Ref@TeX{}} to insert a @code{\vref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
947 macro. The current state of this flag is displayed by the @samp{S<>}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
948 indicator in the mode line of the selection buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
949
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
950 @item V
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
951 @cindex @code{fancyref}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
952 @cindex @code{\fref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
953 @cindex @code{\Fref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
954 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{fancyref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
955 Cycle between @code{\ref}, @code{\fref} and @code{\Fref}. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
956 @code{\fref} and @code{\Fref} macros are defined in the @code{fancyref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
957 LaTeX package. With this key you can force @b{Ref@TeX{}} to insert a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
958 @code{\fref} or @code{\Fref} macro. The current state of this flag is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
959 displayed by the @samp{S<>} indicator in the mode line of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
960 selection buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
961
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
962 @tablesubheading{Exiting}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
963
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
964 @item q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
965 Exit the selection process without inserting any reference into the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
966 buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
967
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
968 @tablesubheading{Controlling what gets displayed}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
969 @vindex reftex-label-menu-flags
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
970 The defaults for the following flags can be configured with the variable
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
971 @code{reftex-label-menu-flags} (@pxref{Options (Referencing Labels)}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
972
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
973 @item c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
974 Toggle the display of the one-line label definition context in the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
975 selection buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
976
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
977 @item F
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
978 Toggle the display of the file borders of a multifile document in the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
979 selection buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
980
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
981 @item t
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
982 Toggle the display of the table of contents in the selection buffer.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
983 With prefix @var{arg}, change the maximum level of toc entries displayed
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
984 to @var{arg}. Chapters are level 1, section are level 2.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
985
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
986 @item #
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
987 Toggle the display of a label counter in the selection buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
988
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
989 @item %
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
990 Toggle the display of labels hidden in comments in the selection
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
991 buffers. Sometimes, you may have commented out parts of your document.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
992 If these parts contain label definitions, @b{Ref@TeX{}} can still display
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
993 and reference these labels.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
994
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
995 @tablesubheading{Updating the buffer}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
996 @item g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
997 Update the menu. This will rebuilt the menu from the internal label
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
998 list, but not reparse the document (see @kbd{r}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
999
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1000 @item r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1001 @vindex reftex-enable-partial-scans
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1002 Reparse the document to update the information on all labels and rebuild
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1003 the menu. If the variable @code{reftex-enable-partial-scans} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1004 non-@code{nil} and your document is a multifile document, this will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1005 reparse only a part of the document (the file in which the label at
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1006 point was defined).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1007
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1008 @item C-u r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1009 Reparse the @emph{entire} document.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1010
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1011 @item s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1012 Switch the label category. After prompting for another label category,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1013 a menu for that category will be shown.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1014
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1015 @item x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1016 Reference a label from an external document. With the LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1017 @code{xr} it is possible to reference labels defined in another
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1018 document. This key will switch to the label menu of an external
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1019 document and let you select a label from there (@pxref{xr (LaTeX
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1020 package),,xr}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1021
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1022 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1023
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1024 @vindex reftex-select-label-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1025 In order to define additional commands for the selection process, the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1026 keymap @code{reftex-select-label-map} may be used.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1027
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1028 @node Builtin Label Environments, Defining Label Environments, Referencing Labels, Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1029 @section Builtin Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1030 @cindex Builtin label environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1031 @cindex Label environments, builtin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1032 @cindex Environments, builtin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1033 @vindex reftex-label-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1034 @vindex reftex-label-alist-builtin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1035
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1036 @b{Ref@TeX{}} needs to be aware of the environments which can be referenced
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1037 with a label (i.e. which carry their own counters). By default, @b{Ref@TeX{}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1038 recognizes all labeled environments and macros discussed in @cite{The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1039 LaTeX Companion by Goossens, Mittelbach & Samarin, Addison-Wesley
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1040 1994.}. These are:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1041
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1042 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1043 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1044 @cindex @code{figure}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1045 @cindex @code{figure*}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1046 @cindex @code{table}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1047 @cindex @code{table*}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1048 @cindex @code{equation}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1049 @cindex @code{eqnarray}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1050 @cindex @code{enumerate}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1051 @cindex @code{\footnote}, LaTeX macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1052 @cindex LaTeX macro @code{footnote}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1053 @cindex LaTeX core
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1054 @code{figure}, @code{figure*}, @code{table}, @code{table*}, @code{equation},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1055 @code{eqnarray}, @code{enumerate}, the @code{\footnote} macro (this is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1056 the LaTeX core stuff)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1057 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1058 @cindex AMS-LaTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1059 @cindex @code{amsmath}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1060 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{amsmath}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1061 @cindex @code{align}, AMS-LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1062 @cindex @code{gather}, AMS-LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1063 @cindex @code{multline}, AMS-LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1064 @cindex @code{flalign}, AMS-LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1065 @cindex @code{alignat}, AMS-LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1066 @cindex @code{xalignat}, AMS-LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1067 @cindex @code{xxalignat}, AMS-LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1068 @cindex @code{subequations}, AMS-LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1069 @code{align}, @code{gather}, @code{multline}, @code{flalign},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1070 @code{alignat}, @code{xalignat}, @code{xxalignat}, @code{subequations}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1071 (from AMS-LaTeX's @file{amsmath.sty} package)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1072 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1073 @cindex @code{endnote}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1074 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{endnote}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1075 @cindex @code{\endnote}, LaTeX macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1076 the @code{\endnote} macro (from @file{endnotes.sty})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1077 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1078 @cindex @code{fancybox}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1079 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{fancybox}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1080 @cindex @code{Beqnarray}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1081 @code{Beqnarray} (@file{fancybox.sty})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1082 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1083 @cindex @code{floatfig}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1084 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{floatfig}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1085 @cindex @code{floatingfig}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1086 @code{floatingfig} (@file{floatfig.sty})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1087 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1088 @cindex @code{longtable}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1089 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{longtable}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1090 @cindex @code{longtable}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1091 @code{longtable} (@file{longtable.sty})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1092 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1093 @cindex @code{picinpar}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1094 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{picinpar}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1095 @cindex @code{figwindow}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1096 @cindex @code{tabwindow}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1097 @code{figwindow}, @code{tabwindow} (@file{picinpar.sty})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1098 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1099 @cindex @code{sidecap}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1100 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{sidecap}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1101 @cindex @code{SCfigure}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1102 @cindex @code{SCtable}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1103 @code{SCfigure}, @code{SCtable} (@file{sidecap.sty})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1104 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1105 @cindex @code{rotating}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1106 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{rotating}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1107 @cindex @code{sidewaysfigure}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1108 @cindex @code{sidewaystable}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1109 @code{sidewaysfigure}, @code{sidewaystable} (@file{rotating.sty})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1110 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1111 @cindex @code{subfig}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1112 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{subfigure}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1113 @cindex @code{subfigure}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1114 @cindex @code{subfigure*}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1115 @code{subfigure}, @code{subfigure*}, the @code{\subfigure} macro
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1116 (@file{subfigure.sty})
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1117 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1118 @cindex @code{supertab}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1119 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{supertab}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1120 @cindex @code{supertabular}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1121 @code{supertabular} (@file{supertab.sty})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1122 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1123 @cindex @code{wrapfig}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1124 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{wrapfig}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1125 @cindex @code{wrapfigure}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1126 @code{wrapfigure} (@file{wrapfig.sty})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1127 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1128
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1129 If you want to use other labeled environments, defined with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1130 @code{\newtheorem}, @b{Ref@TeX{}} needs to be configured to recognize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1131 them (@pxref{Defining Label Environments}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1132
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1133 @node Defining Label Environments, Reference Info, Builtin Label Environments, Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1134 @section Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1135 @cindex Label environments, defining
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1136
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1137 @vindex reftex-label-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1138 @b{Ref@TeX{}} can be configured to recognize additional labeled
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1139 environments and macros. This is done with the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1140 @code{reftex-label-alist} (@pxref{Options (Defining Label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1141 Environments)}). If you are not familiar with Lisp, you can use the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1142 @code{custom} library to configure this rather complex variable. To do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1143 this, use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1144
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1145 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1146 @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET} reftex-label-alist @key{RET}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1147 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1148
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1149 @vindex reftex-label-alist-builtin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1150 Here we will discuss a few examples, in order to make things clearer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1151 It can also be instructive to look at the constant
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1152 @code{reftex-label-alist-builtin} which contains the entries for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1153 all the builtin environments and macros (@pxref{Builtin Label
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1154 Environments}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1155
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1156 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1157 * Theorem and Axiom:: Defined with @code{\newenvironment}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1158 * Quick Equation:: When a macro sets the label type.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1159 * Figure Wrapper:: When a macro argument is a label.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1160 * Adding Magic Words:: Other words for other languages.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1161 * Using \eqref:: How to switch to this AMS-LaTeX macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1162 * Non-Standard Environments:: Environments without \begin and \end
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1163 * Putting it Together:: How to combine many entries.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1164 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1165
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1166 @node Theorem and Axiom, Quick Equation, , Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1167 @subsection Theorem and Axiom Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1168 @cindex @code{theorem}, newtheorem
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1169 @cindex @code{axiom}, newtheorem
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1170 @cindex @code{\newtheorem}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1171
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1172 Suppose you are using @code{\newtheorem} in LaTeX in order to define two
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1173 new environments, @code{theorem} and @code{axiom}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1174
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1175 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1176 \newtheorem@{axiom@}@{Axiom@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1177 \newtheorem@{theorem@}@{Theorem@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1178 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1179
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1180 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1181 to be used like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1182
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1183 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1184 \begin@{axiom@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1185 \label@{ax:first@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1186 ....
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1187 \end@{axiom@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1188 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1189
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1190 So we need to tell @b{Ref@TeX{}} that @code{theorem} and @code{axiom} are new
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1191 labeled environments which define their own label categories. We can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1192 either use Lisp to do this (e.g. in @file{.emacs}) or use the custom
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1193 library. With Lisp it would look like this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1194
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1195 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1196 (setq reftex-label-alist
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1197 '(("axiom" ?a "ax:" "~\\ref@{%s@}" nil ("axiom" "ax.") -2)
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1198 ("theorem" ?h "thr:" "~\\ref@{%s@}" t ("theorem" "th.") -3)))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1199 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1200
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1201 The type indicator characters @code{?a} and @code{?h} are used for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1202 prompts when @b{Ref@TeX{}} queries for a label type. @code{?h}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1203 was chosen for @code{theorem} since @code{?t} is already taken by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1204 @code{table}. Note that also @code{?s}, @code{?f}, @code{?e},
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1205 @code{?i}, @code{?n} are already used for standard environments.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1206
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1207 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1208 The labels for Axioms and Theorems will have the prefixes @samp{ax:} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1209 @samp{thr:}, respectively. @xref{AUCTeX}, for information on how
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1210 AUCTeX can use RefTeX to automatically create labels when a new environment
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1211 is inserted into a buffer. Additionally, the following needs to be
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1212 added to one's .emacs file before AUCTeX will automatically create
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1213 labels for the new environments.
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1214
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1215 @lisp
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1216 (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1217 (lambda ()
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1218 (LaTeX-add-environments
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1219 '("axiom" LaTeX-env-label)
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1220 '("theorem" LaTeX-env-label))))
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1221 @end lisp
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1222
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1223
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1224 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1225 The @samp{~\ref@{%s@}} is a format string indicating how to insert
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1226 references to these labels.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1227
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1228 @noindent
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1229 The next item indicates how to grab context of the label definition.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1230 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1231 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1232 @code{t} means to get it from a default location (from the beginning of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1233 a @code{\macro} or after the @code{\begin} statement). @code{t} is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1234 @emph{not} a good choice for eqnarray and similar environments.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1235 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1236 @code{nil} means to use the text right after the label definition.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1237 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1238 For more complex ways of getting context, see the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1239 @code{reftex-label-alist} (@ref{Options (Defining Label
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1240 Environments)}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1241 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1242
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1243 The following list of strings is used to guess the correct label type
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1244 from the word before point when creating a reference. E.g. if you
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1245 write: @samp{As we have shown in Theorem} and then press @kbd{C-c )},
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1246 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will know that you are looking for a theorem label and
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1247 restrict the menu to only these labels without even asking.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1248
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1249 The final item in each entry is the level at which the environment
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1250 should produce entries in the table of context buffer. If the number is
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1251 positive, the environment will produce numbered entries (like
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1252 @code{\section}), if it is negative the entries will be unnumbered (like
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1253 @code{\section*}). Use this only for environments which structure the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1254 document similar to sectioning commands. For everything else, omit the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1255 item.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1256
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1257 To do the same configuration with @code{customize}, you need to click on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1258 the @code{[INS]} button twice to create two templates and fill them in
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1259 like this:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1260
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1261 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1262 Reftex Label Alist: [Hide]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1263 [INS] [DEL] Package or Detailed : [Value Menu] Detailed:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1264 Environment or \macro : [Value Menu] String: axiom
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1265 Type specification : [Value Menu] Char : a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1266 Label prefix string : [Value Menu] String: ax:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1267 Label reference format: [Value Menu] String: ~\ref@{%s@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1268 Context method : [Value Menu] After label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1269 Magic words:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1270 [INS] [DEL] String: axiom
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1271 [INS] [DEL] String: ax.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1272 [INS]
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1273 [X] Make TOC entry : [Value Menu] Level: -2
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1274 [INS] [DEL] Package or Detailed : [Value Menu] Detailed:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1275 Environment or \macro : [Value Menu] String: theorem
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1276 Type specification : [Value Menu] Char : h
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1277 Label prefix string : [Value Menu] String: thr:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1278 Label reference format: [Value Menu] String: ~\ref@{%s@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1279 Context method : [Value Menu] Default position
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1280 Magic words:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1281 [INS] [DEL] String: theorem
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1282 [INS] [DEL] String: theor.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1283 [INS] [DEL] String: th.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1284 [INS]
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1285 [X] Make TOC entry : [Value Menu] Level: -3
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1286 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1287
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1288 @vindex reftex-insert-label-flags
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1289 @vindex reftex-label-menu-flags
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1290 Depending on how you would like the label insertion and selection for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1291 the new environments to work, you might want to add the letters @samp{a}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1292 and @samp{h} to some of the flags in the variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1293 @code{reftex-insert-label-flags} (@pxref{Options (Creating Labels)})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1294 and @code{reftex-label-menu-flags} (@pxref{Options (Referencing
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1295 Labels)}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1296
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1297
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1298 @node Quick Equation, Figure Wrapper, Theorem and Axiom , Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1299 @subsection Quick Equation Macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1300 @cindex Quick equation macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1301 @cindex Macros as environment wrappers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1302
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1303 Suppose you would like to have a macro for quick equations. It
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1304 could be defined like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1305
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1306 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1307 \newcommand@{\quickeq@}[1]@{\begin@{equation@} #1 \end@{equation@}@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1308 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1309
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1310 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1311 and used like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1312
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1313 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1314 Einstein's equation is \quickeq@{E=mc^2 \label@{eq:einstein@}@}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1315 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1316
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1317 We need to tell @b{Ref@TeX{}} that any label defined in the argument of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1318 @code{\quickeq} is an equation label. Here is how to do this with lisp:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1319
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1320 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1321 (setq reftex-label-alist '(("\\quickeq@{@}" ?e nil nil 1 nil)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1322 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1323
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1324 The first element in this list is now the macro with empty braces as an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1325 @emph{image} of the macro arguments. @code{?e} indicates that this is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1326 an equation label, the different @code{nil} elements indicate to use the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1327 default values for equations. The @samp{1} as the fifth element
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1328 indicates that the context of the label definition should be the 1st
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1329 argument of the macro.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1330
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1331 Here is again how this would look in the customization buffer:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1332
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1333 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1334 Reftex Label Alist: [Hide]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1335 [INS] [DEL] Package or Detailed : [Value Menu] Detailed:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1336 Environment or \macro : [Value Menu] String: \quickeq@{@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1337 Type specification : [Value Menu] Char : e
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1338 Label prefix string : [Value Menu] Default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1339 Label reference format: [Value Menu] Default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1340 Context method : [Value Menu] Macro arg nr: 1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1341 Magic words:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1342 [INS]
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1343 [ ] Make TOC entry : [Value Menu] No entry
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1344 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1345
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1346 @node Figure Wrapper, Adding Magic Words, Quick Equation, Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1347 @subsection Figure Wrapping Macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1348 @cindex Macros as environment wrappers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1349 @cindex Figure wrapping macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1350
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1351 Suppose you want to make figures not directly with the figure
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1352 environment, but with a macro like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1353
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1354 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1355 \newcommand@{\myfig@}[5][tbp]@{%
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1356 \begin@{figure@}[#1]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1357 \epsimp[#5]@{#2@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1358 \caption@{#3@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1359 \label@{#4@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1360 \end@{figure@}@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1361 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1362
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1363 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1364 which would be called like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1365
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1366 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1367 \myfig[htp]@{filename@}@{caption text@}@{label@}@{1@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1368 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1369
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1370 Now we need to tell @b{Ref@TeX{}} that the 4th argument of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1371 @code{\myfig} macro @emph{is itself} a figure label, and where to find
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1372 the context.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1373
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1374 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1375 (setq reftex-label-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1376 '(("\\myfig[]@{@}@{@}@{*@}@{@}" ?f nil nil 3)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1377 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1378
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1379 The empty pairs of brackets indicate the different arguments of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1380 @code{\myfig} macro. The @samp{*} marks the label argument. @code{?f}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1381 indicates that this is a figure label which will be listed together with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1382 labels from normal figure environments. The @code{nil} entries for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1383 prefix and reference format mean to use the defaults for figure labels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1384 The @samp{3} for the context method means to grab the 3rd macro argument
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1385 - the caption.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1386
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1387 As a side effect of this configuration, @code{reftex-label} will now
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1388 insert the required naked label (without the @code{\label} macro) when
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1389 point is directly after the opening parenthesis of a @code{\myfig} macro
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1390 argument.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1391
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1392 Again, here the configuration in the customization buffer:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1393
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1394 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1395 [INS] [DEL] Package or Detailed : [Value Menu] Detailed:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1396 Environment or \macro : [Value Menu] String: \myfig[]@{@}@{@}@{*@}@{@}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1397 Type specification : [Value Menu] Char : f
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1398 Label prefix string : [Value Menu] Default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1399 Label reference format: [Value Menu] Default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1400 Context method : [Value Menu] Macro arg nr: 3
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1401 Magic words:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1402 [INS]
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1403 [ ] Make TOC entry : [Value Menu] No entry
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1404 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1405
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1406 @node Adding Magic Words, Using \eqref, Figure Wrapper, Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1407 @subsection Adding Magic Words
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1408 @cindex Magic words
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1409 @cindex German magic words
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1410 @cindex Label category
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1411
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1412 Sometimes you don't want to define a new label environment or macro, but
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1413 just change the information associated with a label category. Maybe you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1414 want to add some magic words, for another language. Changing only the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1415 information associated with a label category is done by giving
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1416 @code{nil} for the environment name and then specify the items you want
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1417 to define. Here is an example which adds German magic words to all
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1418 predefined label categories.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1419
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1420 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1421 (setq reftex-label-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1422 '((nil ?s nil nil nil ("Kapitel" "Kap." "Abschnitt" "Teil"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1423 (nil ?e nil nil nil ("Gleichung" "Gl."))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1424 (nil ?t nil nil nil ("Tabelle"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1425 (nil ?f nil nil nil ("Figur" "Abbildung" "Abb."))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1426 (nil ?n nil nil nil ("Anmerkung" "Anm."))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1427 (nil ?i nil nil nil ("Punkt"))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1428 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1429
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1430 @node Using \eqref, Non-Standard Environments, Adding Magic Words, Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1431 @subsection Using @code{\eqref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1432 @cindex @code{\eqref}, AMS-LaTeX macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1433 @cindex AMS-LaTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1434 @cindex Label category
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1435
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1436 Another case where one only wants to change the information associated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1437 with the label category is to change the macro which is used for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1438 referencing the label. When working with the AMS-LaTeX stuff, you might
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1439 prefer @code{\eqref} for doing equation references. Here is how to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1440 do this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1441
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1442 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1443 (setq reftex-label-alist '((nil ?e nil "~\\eqref@{%s@}" nil nil)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1444 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1445
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1446 @b{Ref@TeX{}} has also a predefined symbol for this special purpose. The
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1447 following is equivalent to the line above.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1448
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1449 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1450 (setq reftex-label-alist '(AMSTeX))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1451 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1452
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1453 Note that this is automatically done by the @file{amsmath.el} style file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1454 of AUCTeX (@pxref{Style Files}) - so if you use AUCTeX,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1455 this configuration will not be necessary.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1456
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1457 @node Non-Standard Environments, Putting it Together, Using \eqref, Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1458 @subsection Non-standard Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1459 @cindex Non-standard environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1460 @cindex Environments without @code{\begin}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1461 @cindex Special parser functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1462 @cindex Parser functions, for special environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1463
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1464 Some LaTeX packages define environment-like structures without using the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1465 standard @samp{\begin..\end} structure. @b{Ref@TeX{}} cannot parse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1466 these directly, but you can write your own special-purpose parser and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1467 use it instead of the name of an environment in an entry for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1468 @code{reftex-label-alist}. The function should check if point is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1469 currently in the special environment it was written to detect. If so,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1470 it must return a buffer position indicating the start of this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1471 environment. The return value must be @code{nil} on failure to detect
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1472 the environment. The function is called with one argument @var{bound}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1473 If non-@code{nil}, @var{bound} is a boundary for backwards searches
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1474 which should be observed. We will discuss two examples.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1475
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1476 @cindex LaTeX commands, abbreviated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1477
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1478 Some people define abbreviations for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1479 environments, like @code{\be} for @code{\begin@{equation@}}, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1480 @code{\ee} for @code{\end@{equation@}}. The parser function would have
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1481 to search backward for these macros. When the first match is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1482 @code{\ee}, point is not in this environment. When the first match is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1483 @code{\be}, point is in this environment and the function must return
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1484 the beginning of the match. To avoid scanning too far, we can also look
46272
2406cf2da1d4 Fix typo.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 40705
diff changeset
1485 for empty lines which cannot occur inside an equation environment.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1486 Here is the setup:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1487
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1488 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1489 ;; Setup entry in reftex-label-alist, using all defaults for equations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1490 (setq reftex-label-alist '((detect-be-ee ?e nil nil nil nil)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1491
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1492 (defun detect-be-ee (bound)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1493 ;; Search backward for the macros or an empty line
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1494 (if (re-search-backward
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1495 "\\(^[ \t]*\n\\|\\\\ee\\>\\)\\|\\(\\\\be\\>\\)" bound t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1496 (if (match-beginning 2)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1497 (match-beginning 2) ; Return start of environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1498 nil) ; Return nil because env is closed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1499 nil)) ; Return nil for not found
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1500 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1501
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1502 @cindex @code{linguex}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1503 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{linguex}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1504 A more complex example is the @file{linguex.sty} package which defines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1505 list macros @samp{\ex.}, @samp{\a.}, @samp{\b.} etc. for lists which are
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1506 terminated by @samp{\z.} or by an empty line.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1507
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1508 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1509 \ex. \label@{ex:12@} Some text in an exotic language ...
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1510 \a. \label@{ex:13@} more stuff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1511 \b. \label@{ex:14@} still more stuff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1512 \a. List on a deeper level
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1513 \b. Another item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1514 \b. and the third one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1515 \z.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1516 \b. Third item on this level.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1517
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1518 ... text after the empty line terminating all lists
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1519 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1520
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1521 The difficulty is that the @samp{\a.} lists can nest and that an empty
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1522 line terminates all list levels in one go. So we have to count nesting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1523 levels between @samp{\a.} and @samp{\z.}. Here is the implementation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1524 for @b{Ref@TeX{}}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1525
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1526 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1527 (setq reftex-label-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1528 '((detect-linguex ?x "ex:" "~\\ref@{%s@}" nil ("Example" "Ex."))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1529
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1530 (defun detect-linguex (bound)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1531 (let ((cnt 0))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1532 (catch 'exit
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1533 (while
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1534 ;; Search backward for all possible delimiters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1535 (re-search-backward
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1536 (concat "\\(^[ \t]*\n\\)\\|\\(\\\\z\\.\\)\\|"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1537 "\\(\\ex[ig]?\\.\\)\\|\\(\\\\a\\.\\)")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1538 nil t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1539 ;; Check which delimiter was matched.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1540 (cond
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1541 ((match-beginning 1)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1542 ;; empty line terminates all - return nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1543 (throw 'exit nil))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1544 ((match-beginning 2)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1545 ;; \z. terminates one list level - decrease nesting count
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1546 (decf cnt))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1547 ((match-beginning 3)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1548 ;; \ex. : return match unless there was a \z. on this level
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1549 (throw 'exit (if (>= cnt 0) (match-beginning 3) nil)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1550 ((match-beginning 4)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1551 ;; \a. : return match when on level 0, otherwise
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1552 ;; increment nesting count
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1553 (if (>= cnt 0)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1554 (throw 'exit (match-beginning 4))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1555 (incf cnt))))))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1556 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1557
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1558 @node Putting it Together, , Non-Standard Environments, Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1559 @subsection Putting it all together
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1560
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1561 When you have to put several entries into @code{reftex-label-alist}, just
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1562 put them after each other in a list, or create that many templates in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1563 the customization buffer. Here is a lisp example which uses several of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1564 the entries described above:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1565
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1566 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1567 (setq reftex-label-alist
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1568 '(("axiom" ?a "ax:" "~\\ref@{%s@}" nil ("axiom" "ax.") -2)
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1569 ("theorem" ?h "thr:" "~\\ref@{%s@}" t ("theorem" "theor." "th.") -3)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1570 ("\\quickeq@{@}" ?e nil nil 1 nil)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1571 AMSTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1572 ("\\myfig[]@{@}@{@}@{*@}@{@}" ?f nil nil 3)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1573 (detect-linguex ?x "ex:" "~\\ref@{%s@}" nil ("Example" "Ex."))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1574 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1575
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1576 @node Reference Info, xr (LaTeX package), Defining Label Environments, Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1577 @section Reference Info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1578 @findex reftex-view-crossref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1579 @findex reftex-mouse-view-crossref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1580 @cindex Cross-references, displaying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1581 @cindex Reference info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1582 @cindex Displaying cross-references
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1583 @cindex Viewing cross-references
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1584 @kindex C-c &
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
1585 @kindex S-mouse-2
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1586
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
1587 When point is idle for more than @code{reftex-idle-time} seconds on the
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
1588 argument of a @code{\ref} macro, the echo area will display some
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
1589 information about the label referenced there. Note that the information
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
1590 is only displayed if the echo area is not occupied by a different
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
1591 message.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1592
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1593 @b{Ref@TeX{}} can also display the label definition corresponding to a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1594 @code{\ref} macro, or all reference locations corresponding to a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1595 @code{\label} macro. @xref{Viewing Cross-References}, for more
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1596 information.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1597
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1598 @node xr (LaTeX package), varioref (LaTeX package), Reference Info, Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1599 @section @code{xr}: Cross-Document References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1600 @cindex @code{xr}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1601 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{xr}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1602 @cindex @code{\externaldocument}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1603 @cindex External documents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1604 @cindex References to external documents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1605 @cindex Cross-document references
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1606
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1607 The LaTeX package @code{xr} makes it possible to create references to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1608 labels defined in external documents. The preamble of a document using
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1609 @code{xr} will contain something like this:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1610
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1611 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1612 \usepackage@{xr@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1613 \externaldocument[V1-]@{volume1@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1614 \externaldocument[V3-]@{volume3@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1615 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1616
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1617 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1618 and we can make references to any labels defined in these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1619 external documents by using the prefixes @samp{V1-} and @samp{V3-},
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1620 respectively.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1621
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1622 @b{Ref@TeX{}} can be used to create such references as well. Start the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1623 referencing process normally, by pressing @kbd{C-c )}. Select a label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1624 type if necessary. When you see the label selection buffer, pressing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1625 @kbd{x} will switch to the label selection buffer of one of the external
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1626 documents. You may then select a label as before and @b{Ref@TeX{}} will
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1627 insert it along with the required prefix.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1628
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1629 For this kind of inter-document cross-references, saving of parsing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1630 information and the use of multiple selection buffers can mean a large
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1631 speed-up (@pxref{Optimizations}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1632
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1633 @node varioref (LaTeX package), fancyref (LaTeX package), xr (LaTeX package), Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1634 @section @code{varioref}: Variable Page References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1635 @cindex @code{varioref}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1636 @cindex @code{\vref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1637 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{varioref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1638 @vindex reftex-vref-is-default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1639 @code{varioref} is a frequently used LaTeX package to create
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1640 cross--references with page information. When you want to make a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1641 reference with the @code{\vref} macro, just press the @kbd{v} key in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1642 selection buffer to toggle between @code{\ref} and @code{\vref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1643 (@pxref{Referencing Labels}). The mode line of the selection buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1644 shows the current status of this switch. If you find that you almost
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1645 always use @code{\vref}, you may want to make it the default by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1646 customizing the variable @code{reftex-vref-is-default}. If this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1647 toggling seems too inconvenient, you can also use the command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1648 @code{reftex-varioref-vref}@footnote{bind it to @kbd{C-c v}.}.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1649 Or use AUCTeX to create your macros (@pxref{AUCTeX}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1650
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1651 @node fancyref (LaTeX package), , varioref (LaTeX package), Labels and References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1652 @section @code{fancyref}: Fancy Cross References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1653 @cindex @code{fancyref}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1654 @cindex @code{\fref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1655 @cindex @code{\Fref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1656 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{fancyref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1657 @vindex reftex-fref-is-default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1658 @code{fancyref} is a LaTeX package where a macro call like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1659 @code{\fref@{@var{fig:map-of-germany}@}} creates not only the number of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1660 the referenced counter but also the complete text around it, like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1661 @samp{Figure 3 on the preceding page}. In order to make it work you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1662 need to use label prefixes like @samp{fig:} consistently - something
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1663 @b{Ref@TeX{}} does automatically. When you want to make a reference
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1664 with the @code{\fref} macro, just press the @kbd{V} key in the selection
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1665 buffer to cycle between @code{\ref}, @code{\fref} and @code{\Fref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1666 (@pxref{Referencing Labels}). The mode line of the selection buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1667 shows the current status of this switch. If this cycling seems
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1668 inconvenient, you can also use the commands @code{reftex-fancyref-fref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1669 and @code{reftex-fancyref-Fref}@footnote{bind them to @kbd{C-c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1670 f} and @kbd{C-c F}.}. Or use AUCTeX to create your macros
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1671 (@pxref{AUCTeX}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1672
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1673 @node Citations, Index Support, Labels and References, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1674 @chapter Citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1675 @cindex Citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1676 @cindex @code{\cite}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1677
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1678 Citations in LaTeX are done with the @code{\cite} macro or variations of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1679 it. The argument of the macro is a citation key which identifies an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1680 article or book in either a BibTeX database file or in an explicit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1681 @code{thebibliography} environment in the document. @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1682 support for citations helps to select the correct key quickly.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1683
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1684 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1685 * Creating Citations:: How to create them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1686 * Citation Styles:: Natbib, Harvard, Chicago and Co.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1687 * Citation Info:: View the corresponding database entry.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1688 * Chapterbib and Bibunits:: Multiple bibliographies in a Document.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1689 * Citations Outside LaTeX:: How to make citations in Emails etc.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1690 * BibTeX Database Subsets:: Extract parts of a big database.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1691 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1692
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1693 @node Creating Citations, Citation Styles, , Citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1694 @section Creating Citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1695 @cindex Creating citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1696 @cindex Citations, creating
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1697 @findex reftex-citation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1698 @kindex C-c [
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1699 @cindex Selection buffer, citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1700 @cindex Selection process
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1701
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1702 In order to create a citation, press @kbd{C-c [}. @b{Ref@TeX{}} then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1703 prompts for a regular expression which will be used to search through
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1704 the database and present the list of matches to choose from in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1705 selection process similar to that for selecting labels
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1706 (@pxref{Referencing Labels}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1707
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1708 The regular expression uses an extended syntax: @samp{&&} defines a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1709 logic @code{and} for regular expressions. For example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1710 @samp{Einstein&&Bose} will match all articles which mention
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1711 Bose-Einstein condensation, or which are co-authored by Bose and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1712 Einstein. When entering the regular expression, you can complete on
46918
82d113655734 Minor spelling and grammar corrections.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 46684
diff changeset
1713 known citation keys. RefTeX also offers a default when prompting for a
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
1714 regular expression. This default is the word before the cursor or the
46918
82d113655734 Minor spelling and grammar corrections.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 46684
diff changeset
1715 word before the current @samp{\cite} command. Sometimes this may be a
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1716 good search key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1717
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1718 @cindex @code{\bibliography}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1719 @cindex @code{thebibliography}, LaTeX environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1720 @cindex @code{BIBINPUTS}, environment variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1721 @cindex @code{TEXBIB}, environment variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1722 @b{Ref@TeX{}} prefers to use BibTeX database files specified with a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1723 @code{\bibliography} macro to collect its information. Just like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1724 BibTeX, it will search for the specified files in the current directory
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1725 and along the path given in the environment variable @code{BIBINPUTS}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1726 If you do not use BibTeX, but the document contains an explicit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1727 @code{thebibliography} environment, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will collect its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1728 information from there. Note that in this case the information
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1729 presented in the selection buffer will just be a copy of relevant
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1730 @code{\bibitem} entries, not the structured listing available with
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1731 BibTeX database files.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1732
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1733 @kindex ?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1734 In the selection buffer, the following keys provide special commands. A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1735 summary of this information is always available from the selection
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1736 process by pressing @kbd{?}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1737
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1738 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1739 @tablesubheading{General}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1740 @item ?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1741 Show a summary of available commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1742
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1743 @item 0-9,-
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1744 Prefix argument.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1745
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1746 @tablesubheading{Moving around}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1747 @item n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1748 Go to next article.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1749
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1750 @item p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1751 Go to previous article.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1752
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1753 @tablesubheading{Access to full database entries}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1754 @item @key{SPC}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1755 Show the database entry corresponding to the article at point, in
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1756 another window. See also the @kbd{f} key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1757
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1758 @item f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1759 Toggle follow mode. When follow mode is active, the other window will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1760 always display the full database entry of the current article. This is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1761 equivalent to pressing @key{SPC} after each cursor motion. With BibTeX
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1762 entries, follow mode can be rather slow.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1763
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1764 @tablesubheading{Selecting entries and creating the citation}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1765 @item @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1766 Insert a citation referencing the article at point into the buffer from
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1767 which the selection process was started.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1768
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
1769 @item mouse-2
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1770 @vindex reftex-highlight-selection
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1771 Clicking with mouse button 2 on a citation will accept it like @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1772 would. See also variable @code{reftex-highlight-selection}, @ref{Options
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1773 (Misc)}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1774
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1775 @item m
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1776 Mark the current entry. When one or several entries are marked,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1777 pressing @kbd{a} or @kbd{A} accepts all marked entries. Also,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1778 @key{RET} behaves like the @kbd{a} key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1779
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1780 @item u
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1781 Unmark a marked entry.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1782
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1783 @item a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1784 Accept all (marked) entries in the selection buffer and create a single
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1785 @code{\cite} macro referring to them.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1786
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1787 @item A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1788 Accept all (marked) entries in the selection buffer and create a
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1789 separate @code{\cite} macro for each of it.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1790
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1791 @item e
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1792 Create a new BibTeX database file which contains all @i{marked} entries
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1793 in the selection buffer. If no entries are marked, all entries are
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1794 selected.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1795
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1796 @item E
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1797 Create a new BibTeX database file which contains all @i{unmarked}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1798 entries in the selection buffer. If no entries are marked, all entries
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1799 are selected.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1800
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1801 @item @key{TAB}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1802 Enter a citation key with completion. This may also be a key which does
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1803 not yet exist.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1804
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1805 @item .
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1806 Show insertion point in another window. This is the point from where you
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1807 called @code{reftex-citation}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1808
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1809 @tablesubheading{Exiting}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1810 @item q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1811 Exit the selection process without inserting a citation into the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1812 buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1813
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1814 @tablesubheading{Updating the buffer}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1815
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1816 @item g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1817 Start over with a new regular expression. The full database will be
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1818 rescanned with the new expression (see also @kbd{r}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1819
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1820 @c FIXME: Should we use something else here? r is usually rescan!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1821 @item r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1822 Refine the current selection with another regular expression. This will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1823 @emph{not} rescan the entire database, but just the already selected
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1824 entries.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1825
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1826 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1827
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1828 @vindex reftex-select-bib-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1829 In order to define additional commands for this selection process, the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1830 keymap @code{reftex-select-bib-map} may be used.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1831
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1832 @node Citation Styles, Citation Info, Creating Citations, Citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1833 @section Citation Styles
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1834 @cindex Citation styles
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1835 @cindex Citation styles, @code{natbib}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1836 @cindex Citation styles, @code{harvard}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1837 @cindex Citation styles, @code{chicago}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1838 @cindex @code{natbib}, citation style
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1839 @cindex @code{harvard}, citation style
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1840 @cindex @code{chicago}, citation style
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1841
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1842 @vindex reftex-cite-format
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1843 The standard LaTeX macro @code{\cite} works well with numeric or simple
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1844 key citations. To deal with the more complex task of author-year
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1845 citations as used in many natural sciences, a variety of packages has
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1846 been developed which define derived forms of the @code{\cite} macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1847 @b{Ref@TeX{}} can be configured to produce these citation macros as well by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1848 setting the variable @code{reftex-cite-format}. For the most commonly
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1849 used packages (@code{natbib}, @code{harvard}, @code{chicago}) this may
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1850 be done from the menu, under @code{Ref->Citation Styles}. Since there
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1851 are usually several macros to create the citations, executing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1852 @code{reftex-citation} (@kbd{C-c [}) starts by prompting for the correct
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1853 macro. For the Natbib style, this looks like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1854
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1855 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1856 SELECT A CITATION FORMAT
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1857
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1858 [^M] \cite@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1859 [t] \citet@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1860 [T] \citet*@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1861 [p] \citep@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1862 [P] \citep*@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1863 [e] \citep[e.g.][]@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1864 [s] \citep[see][]@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1865 [a] \citeauthor@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1866 [A] \citeauthor*@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1867 [y] \citeyear@{%l@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1868 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1869
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1870 @vindex reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1871 If cite formats contain empty paris of square brackets, RefTeX can
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1872 will prompt for values of these optional arguments if you call the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1873 @code{reftex-citation} command with a @kbd{C-u} prefix.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1874 Following the most generic of these packages, @code{natbib}, the builtin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1875 citation packages always accept the @kbd{t} key for a @emph{textual}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1876 citation (like: @code{Jones et al. (1997) have shown...}) as well as
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1877 the @kbd{p} key for a parenthetical citation (like: @code{As shown
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1878 earlier (Jones et al, 1997)}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1879
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1880 To make one of these styles the default, customize the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1881 @code{reftex-cite-format} or put into @file{.emacs}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1882
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1883 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1884 (setq reftex-cite-format 'natbib)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1885 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1886
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1887 You can also use AUCTeX style files to automatically set the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1888 citation style based on the @code{usepackage} commands in a given
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1889 document. @xref{Style Files}, for information on how to set up the style
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1890 files correctly.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1891
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1892 @node Citation Info, Chapterbib and Bibunits, Citation Styles, Citations, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1893 @section Citation Info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1894 @cindex Displaying citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1895 @cindex Citations, displaying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1896 @cindex Citation info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1897 @cindex Viewing citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1898 @kindex C-c &
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
1899 @kindex S-mouse-2
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1900 @findex reftex-view-crossref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1901 @findex reftex-mouse-view-crossref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1902
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
1903 When point is idle for more than @code{reftex-idle-time} seconds on the
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
1904 argument of a @code{\cite} macro, the echo area will display some
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
1905 information about the article cited there. Note that the information is
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
1906 only displayed if the echo area is not occupied by a different message.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1907
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1908 @b{Ref@TeX{}} can also display the @code{\bibitem} or BibTeX database
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1909 entry corresponding to a @code{\cite} macro, or all citation locations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1910 corresponding to a @code{\bibitem} or BibTeX database entry.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1911 @xref{Viewing Cross-References}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1912
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1913 @node Chapterbib and Bibunits, Citations Outside LaTeX, Citation Info, Citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1914 @section Chapterbib and Bibunits
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1915 @cindex @code{chapterbib}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1916 @cindex @code{bibunits}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1917 @cindex Bibliographies, multiple
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1918
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1919 @code{chapterbib} and @code{bibunits} are two LaTeX packages which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1920 produce multiple bibliographies in a document. This is no problem for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1921 @b{Ref@TeX{}} as long as all bibliographies use the same BibTeX database
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1922 files. If they do not, it is best to have each document part in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1923 separate file (as it is required for @code{chapterbib} anyway). Then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1924 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will still scan the locally relevant databases correctly. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1925 you have multiple bibliographies within a @emph{single file}, this may
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1926 or may not be the case.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1927
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1928 @node Citations Outside LaTeX, BibTeX Database Subsets, Chapterbib and Bibunits, Citations
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1929 @section Citations outside LaTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1930 @cindex Citations outside LaTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1931 @vindex reftex-default-bibliography
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1932
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1933 The command @code{reftex-citation} can also be executed outside a LaTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1934 buffer. This can be useful to reference articles in the mail buffer and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1935 other documents. You should @emph{not} enter @code{reftex-mode} for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1936 this, just execute the command. The list of BibTeX files will in this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1937 case be taken from the variable @code{reftex-default-bibliography}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1938 Setting the variable @code{reftex-cite-format} to the symbol
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1939 @code{locally} does a decent job of putting all relevant information
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1940 about a citation directly into the buffer. Here is the lisp code to add
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1941 the @kbd{C-c [} binding to the mail buffer. It also provides a local
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1942 binding for @code{reftex-cite-format}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1943
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1944 @lisp
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1945 (add-hook 'mail-setup-hook
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1946 (lambda () (define-key mail-mode-map "\C-c["
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1947 (lambda () (interactive)
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1948 (require 'reftex)
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1949 (let ((reftex-cite-format 'locally))
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1950 (reftex-citation))))))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1951 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1952
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1953 @node BibTeX Database Subsets, , Citations Outside LaTeX, Citations
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1954 @section Database Subsets
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1955 @cindex BibTeX database subsets
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1956 @findex reftex-create-bibtex-file
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1957
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1958 @b{Ref@TeX{}} offers two ways to create a new BibTeX database file.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1959
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1960 The first option produces a file which contains only the entries
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1961 actually referenced in the current document. This can be useful if
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1962 the database in only meant for a single document and you want to clean
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1963 it of old and unused ballast. It can also be useful while writing a
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1964 document together with collaborators, in order to avoid sending around
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1965 the entire (possibly very large) database. To create the file, use
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1966 @kbd{M-x reftex-create-bibtex-file}, also available from the menu
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1967 under @code{Ref->Global Actions->Create Bibtex File}. The command will
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1968 prompt for a BibTeX file name and write the extracted entries to that
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1969 file.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1970
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1971 The second option makes use of the selection process started by the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1972 command @kbd{C-c [} (@pxref{Creating Citations}). This command uses a
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1973 regular expression to select entries, and lists them in a formatted
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1974 selection buffer. After pressing the @kbd{e} key (mnemonics: Export),
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1975 the command will prompt for the name of a new BibTeX file and write
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1976 the selected entries to that file. You can also first mark some
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1977 entries in the selection buffer with the @kbd{m} key and then export
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1978 either the @i{marked} entries (with the @kbd{e} key) or the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1979 @i{unmarked} entries (with the @kbd{E} key).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1980
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1981 @node Index Support, Viewing Cross-References, Citations, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1982 @chapter Index Support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1983 @cindex Index Support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1984 @cindex @code{\index}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1985
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1986 LaTeX has builtin support for creating an Index. The LaTeX core
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1987 supports two different indices, the standard index and a glossary. With
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1988 the help of special LaTeX packages (@file{multind.sty} or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1989 @file{index.sty}), any number of indices can be supported.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1990
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1991 Index entries are created with the @code{\index@{@var{entry}@}} macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1992 All entries defined in a document are written out to the @file{.aux}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1993 file. A separate tool must be used to convert this information into a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1994 nicely formatted index. Tools used with LaTeX include @code{MakeIndex}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
1995 and @code{xindy}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1996
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1997 Indexing is a very difficult task. It must follow strict conventions to
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1998 make the index consistent and complete. There are basically two
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1999 approaches one can follow, and both have their merits.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2000
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2001 @enumerate
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2002 @item
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2003 Part of the indexing should already be done with the markup. The
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2004 document structure should be reflected in the index, so when starting
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2005 new sections, the basic topics of the section should be indexed. If the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2006 document contains definitions, theorems or the like, these should all
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2007 correspond to appropriate index entries. This part of the index can
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2008 very well be developed along with the document. Often it is worthwhile
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2009 to define special purpose macros which define an item and at the same
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2010 time make an index entry, possibly with special formatting to make the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2011 reference page in the index bold or underlined. To make @b{Ref@TeX{}}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2012 support for indexing possible, these special macros must be added to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2013 @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s configuration (@pxref{Defining Index Macros}).
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2014
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2015 @item
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2016 The rest of the index is often just a collection of where in the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2017 document certain words or phrases are being used. This part is
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2018 difficult to develop along with the document, because consistent entries
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2019 for each occurrence are needed and are best selected when the document
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2020 is ready. @b{Ref@TeX{}} supports this with an @emph{index phrases file}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2021 which collects phrases and helps indexing the phrases globally.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2022 @end enumerate
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2023
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2024 Before you start, you need to make sure that @b{Ref@TeX{}} knows about
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2025 the index style being used in the current document. @b{Ref@TeX{}} has
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2026 builtin support for the default @code{\index} and @code{\glossary}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2027 macros. Other LaTeX packages, like the @file{multind} or @file{index}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2028 package, redefine the @code{\index} macro to have an additional
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2029 argument, and @b{Ref@TeX{}} needs to be configured for those. A
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2030 sufficiently new version of AUCTeX (9.10c or later) will do this
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2031 automatically. If you really don't use AUCTeX (you should!), this
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2032 configuration needs to be done by hand with the menu (@code{Ref->Index
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2033 Style}), or globally for all your documents with
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2034
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2035 @lisp
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2036 (setq reftex-index-macros '(multind)) @r{or}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2037 (setq reftex-index-macros '(index))
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2038 @end lisp
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2039
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2040 @menu
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2041 * Creating Index Entries:: Macros and completion of entries.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2042 * The Index Phrases File:: A special file for global indexing.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2043 * Displaying and Editing the Index:: The index editor.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2044 * Builtin Index Macros:: The index macros RefTeX knows about.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2045 * Defining Index Macros:: ... and macros it doesn't.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2046 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2047
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2048 @node Creating Index Entries, The Index Phrases File, , Index Support
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2049 @section Creating Index Entries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2050 @cindex Creating index entries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2051 @cindex Index entries, creating
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2052 @kindex C-c <
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2053 @findex reftex-index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2054 @kindex C-c /
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2055 @findex reftex-index-selection-or-word
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2056
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2057 In order to index the current selection or the word at the cursor press
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2058 @kbd{C-c /} (@code{reftex-index-selection-or-word}). This causes the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2059 selection or word @samp{@var{word}} to be replaced with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2060 @samp{\index@{@var{word}@}@var{word}}. The macro which is used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2061 (@code{\index} by default) can be configured with the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2062 @code{reftex-index-default-macro}. When the command is called with a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2063 prefix argument (@kbd{C-u C-c /}), you get a chance to edit the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2064 generated index entry. Use this to change the case of the word or to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2065 make the entry a subentry, for example by entering
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2066 @samp{main!sub!@var{word}}. When called with two raw @kbd{C-u} prefixes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2067 (@kbd{C-u C-u C-c /}), you will be asked for the index macro as well.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2068 When there is nothing selected and no word at point, this command will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2069 just call @code{reftex-index}, described below.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2070
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2071 In order to create a general index entry, press @kbd{C-c <}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2072 (@code{reftex-index}). @b{Ref@TeX{}} will prompt for one of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2073 available index macros and for its arguments. Completion will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2074 available for the index entry and, if applicable, the index tag. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2075 index tag is a string identifying one of multiple indices. With the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2076 @file{multind} and @file{index} packages, this tag is the first argument
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2077 to the redefined @code{\index} macro.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2078
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2079 @node The Index Phrases File, Displaying and Editing the Index, Creating Index Entries, Index Support
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2080 @section The Index Phrases File
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2081 @cindex Index phrase file
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2082 @cindex Phrase file
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2083 @kindex C-c |
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2084 @findex reftex-index-visit-phrases-buffer
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2085 @cindex Macro definition lines, in phrase buffer
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2086
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2087 @b{Ref@TeX{}} maintains a file in which phrases can be collected for
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2088 later indexing. The file is located in the same directory as the master
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2089 file of the document and has the extension @file{.rip} (@b{R}eftex
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2090 @b{I}ndex @b{P}hrases). You can create or visit the file with @kbd{C-c
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2091 |} (@code{reftex-index-visit-phrases-buffer}). If the file is empty it
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2092 is initialized by inserting a file header which contains the definition
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2093 of the available index macros. This list is initialized from
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2094 @code{reftex-index-macros} (@pxref{Defining Index Macros}). You can
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2095 edit the header as needed, but if you define new LaTeX indexing macros,
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2096 don't forget to add them to @code{reftex-index-macros} as well. Here is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2097 a phrase file header example:
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2098
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2099 @example
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2100 % -*- mode: reftex-index-phrases -*-
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2101 % Key Macro Format Repeat
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2102 %----------------------------------------------------------
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2103 >>>INDEX_MACRO_DEFINITION: i \index@{%s@} t
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2104 >>>INDEX_MACRO_DEFINITION: I \index*@{%s@} nil
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2105 >>>INDEX_MACRO_DEFINITION: g \glossary@{%s@} t
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2106 >>>INDEX_MACRO_DEFINITION: n \index*[name]@{%s@} nil
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2107 %----------------------------------------------------------
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2108 @end example
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2109
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2110 The macro definition lines consist of a unique letter identifying a
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2111 macro, a format string and the @var{repeat} flag, all separated by
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2112 @key{TAB}. The format string shows how the macro is to be applied, the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2113 @samp{%s} will be replaced with the index entry. The repeat flag
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2114 indicates if @var{word} is indexed by the macro as
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2115 @samp{\index@{@var{word}@}} (@var{repeat} = @code{nil}) or as
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2116 @samp{\index@{@var{word}@}@var{word}} (@var{repeat} = @code{t}). In the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2117 above example it is assumed that the macro @code{\index*@{@var{word}@}}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2118 already typesets its argument in the text, so that it is unnecessary to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2119 repeat @var{word} outside the macro.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2120
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2121 @menu
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2122 * Collecting Phrases:: Collecting from document or external.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2123 * Consistency Checks:: Check for duplicates etc.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2124 * Global Indexing:: The interactive indexing process.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2125 @end menu
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2126
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2127 @node Collecting Phrases, Consistency Checks, , The Index Phrases File
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2128 @subsection Collecting Phrases
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2129 @cindex Collecting index phrases
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2130 @cindex Index phrases, collection
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2131 @cindex Phrases, collecting
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2132
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2133 Phrases for indexing can be collected while writing the document. The
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2134 command @kbd{C-c \} (@code{reftex-index-phrase-selection-or-word})
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2135 copies the current selection (if active) or the word near point into the
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2136 phrases buffer. It then selects this buffer, so that the phrase line
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2137 can be edited. To return to the LaTeX document, press @kbd{C-c C-c}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2138 (@code{reftex-index-phrases-save-and-return}).
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2139
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2140 You can also prepare the list of index phrases in a different way and
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2141 copy it into the phrases file. For example you might want to start from
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2142 a word list of the document and remove all words which should not be
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2143 indexed.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2144
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2145 The phrase lines in the phrase buffer must have a specific format.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2146 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will use font-lock to indicate if a line has the proper
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2147 format. A phrase line looks like this:
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2148
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2149 @example
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2150 [@var{key}] <TABs> @var{phrase} [<TABs> @var{arg}[&&@var{arg}]... [ || @var{arg}]...]
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2151 @end example
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2152
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2153 @code{<TABs>} stands for white space containing at least one @key{TAB}.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2154 @var{key} must be at the start of the line and is the character
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2155 identifying one of the macros defined in the file header. It is
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2156 optional - when omitted, the first macro definition line in the file
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2157 will be used for this phrase. The @var{phrase} is the phrase to be
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2158 searched for when indexing. It may contain several words separated by
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2159 spaces. By default the search phrase is also the text entered as
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2160 argument of the index macro. If you want the index entry to be
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2161 different from the search phrase, enter another @key{TAB} and the index
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2162 argument @var{arg}. If you want to have each match produce several
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2163 index entries, separate the different index arguments with @samp{ &&
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2164 }@footnote{@samp{&&} with optional spaces, see
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2165 @code{reftex-index-phrases-logical-and-regexp}.}. If you want to be
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2166 able to choose at each match between several different index arguments,
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2167 separate them with @samp{ || }@footnote{@samp{||} with optional spaces,
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2168 see @code{reftex-index-phrases-logical-or-regexp}.}. Here is an
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2169 example:
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2170
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2171 @example
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2172 %--------------------------------------------------------------------
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2173 I Sun
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2174 i Planet Planets
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2175 i Vega Stars!Vega
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2176 Jupiter Planets!Jupiter
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2177 i Mars Planets!Mars || Gods!Mars || Chocolate Bars!Mars
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2178 i Pluto Planets!Pluto && Kuiper Belt Objects!Pluto
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2179 @end example
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2180
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2181
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2182 So @samp{Sun} will be indexed directly as @samp{\index*@{Sun@}}, while
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2183 @samp{Planet} will be indexed as @samp{\index@{Planets@}Planet}.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2184 @samp{Vega} will be indexed as a subitem of @samp{Stars}. The
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2185 @samp{Jupiter} line will also use the @samp{i} macro as it was the first
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2186 macro definition in the file header (see above example). At each
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2187 occurrence of @samp{Mars} you will be able choose between indexing it as
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2188 a subitem of @samp{Planets}, @samp{Gods} or @samp{Chocolate Bars}.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2189 Finally, every occurrence of @samp{Pluto} will be indexed as
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2190 @samp{\index@{Planets!Pluto@}\index@{Kuiper Belt Objects!Pluto@}Pluto}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2191 and will therefore create two different index entries.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2192
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2193 @node Consistency Checks, Global Indexing, Collecting Phrases, The Index Phrases File
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2194 @subsection Consistency Checks
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2195 @cindex Index phrases, consistency checks
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2196 @cindex Phrases, consistency checks
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2197 @cindex Consistency check for index phrases
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2198
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2199 @kindex C-c C-s
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2200 Before indexing the phrases in the phrases buffer, they should be
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2201 checked carefully for consistency. A first step is to sort the phrases
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2202 alphabetically - this is done with the command @kbd{C-c C-s}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2203 (@code{reftex-index-sort-phrases}). It will sort all phrases in the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2204 buffer alphabetically by search phrase. If you want to group certain
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2205 phrases and only sort within the groups, insert empty lines between the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2206 groups. Sorting will only change the sequence of phrases within each
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2207 group (see the variable @code{reftex-index-phrases-sort-in-blocks}).
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2208
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2209 @kindex C-c C-i
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2210 A useful command is @kbd{C-c C-i} (@code{reftex-index-phrases-info})
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2211 which lists information about the phrase at point, including an example
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2212 of how the index entry will look like and the number of expected matches
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2213 in the document.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2214
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2215 @kindex C-c C-t
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2216 Another important check is to find out if there are double or
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2217 overlapping entries in the buffer. For example if you are first
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2218 searching and indexing @samp{Mars} and then @samp{Planet Mars}, the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2219 second phrase will not match because of the index macro inserted before
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2220 @samp{Mars} earlier. The command @kbd{C-c C-t}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2221 (@code{reftex-index-find-next-conflict-phrase}) finds the next phrase in
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2222 the buffer which is either duplicate or a subphrase of another phrase.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2223 In order to check the whole buffer like this, start at the beginning and
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2224 execute this command repeatedly.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2225
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2226 @node Global Indexing, , Consistency Checks, The Index Phrases File
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2227 @subsection Global Indexing
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2228 @cindex Global indexing
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2229 @cindex Indexing, global
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2230 @cindex Indexing, from @file{phrases} buffer
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2231
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2232 Once the index phrases have been collected and organized, you are set
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2233 for global indexing. I recommend to do this only on an otherwise
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2234 finished document. Global indexing starts from the phrases buffer.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2235 There are several commands which start indexing: @kbd{C-c C-x} acts on
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2236 the current phrase line, @kbd{C-c C-r} on all lines in the current
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2237 region and @kbd{C-c C-a} on all phrase lines in the buffer. It is
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2238 probably good to do indexing in small chunks since your concentration
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2239 may not last long enough to do everything in one go.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2240
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2241 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will start at the first phrase line and search the phrase
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2242 globally in the whole document. At each match it will stop, compute the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2243 replacement string and offer you the following choices@footnote{Windows
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2244 users: Restrict yourself to the described keys during indexing. Pressing
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2245 @key{Help} at the indexing prompt can apparently hang Emacs.}:
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2246
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2247 @table @kbd
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2248 @item y
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2249 Replace this match with the proposed string.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2250 @item n
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2251 Skip this match.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2252 @item !
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2253 Replace this and all further matches in this file.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2254 @item q
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2255 Skip this match, start with next file.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2256 @item Q
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2257 Skip this match, start with next phrase.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2258 @item o
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2259 Select a different indexing macro for this match.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2260 @item 1-9
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2261 Select one of multiple index keys (those separated with @samp{||}).
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2262 @item e
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2263 Edit the replacement text.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2264 @item C-r
40705
421e0a91a1d1 Replace M-C- with C-M-
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39267
diff changeset
2265 Recursive edit. Use @kbd{C-M-c} to return to the indexing process.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2266 @item s
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2267 Save this buffer and ask again about the current match.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2268 @item S
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2269 Save all document buffers and ask again about the current match.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2270 @item C-g
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2271 Abort the indexing process.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2272 @end table
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2273
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2274 The @samp{Find and Index in Document} menu in the phrases buffer also
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2275 lists a few options for the indexing process. The options have
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2276 associated customization variables to set the defaults (@pxref{Options
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2277 (Index Support)}). Here is a short explanation of what the options do:
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2278
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2279 @table @i
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2280 @item Match Whole Words
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2281 When searching for index phrases, make sure whole words are matched.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2282 This should probably always be on.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2283 @item Case Sensitive Search
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2284 Search case sensitively for phrases. I recommend to have this setting
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2285 off, in order to match the capitalized words at the beginning of a
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2286 sentence, and even typos. You can always say @emph{no} at a match you
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2287 do not like.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2288 @item Wrap Long Lines
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2289 Inserting index macros increases the line length. Turn this option on
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2290 to allow @b{Ref@TeX{}} to wrap long lines.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2291 @item Skip Indexed Matches
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2292 When this is on, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will at each match try to figure out if
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2293 this match is already indexed. A match is considered indexed if it is
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2294 either the argument of an index macro, or if an index macro is directly
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2295 (without whitespace separation) before or after the match. Index macros
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2296 are those configured in @code{reftex-index-macros}. Intended for
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2297 re-indexing a documents after changes have been made.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2298 @end table
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2299
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2300 Even though indexing should be the last thing you do to a document, you
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2301 are bound to make changes afterwards. Indexing then has to be applied
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2302 to the changed regions. The command
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2303 @code{reftex-index-phrases-apply-to-region} is designed for this
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2304 purpose. When called from a LaTeX document with active region, it will
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2305 apply @code{reftex-index-all-phrases} to the current region.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2306
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2307 @node Displaying and Editing the Index, Builtin Index Macros, The Index Phrases File, Index Support
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2308 @section Displaying and Editing the Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2309 @cindex Displaying the Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2310 @cindex Editing the Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2311 @cindex Index entries, creating
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2312 @cindex Index, displaying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2313 @cindex Index, editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2314 @kindex C-c >
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2315 @findex reftex-display-index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2316
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2317 In order to compile and display the index, press @kbd{C-c >}. If the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2318 document uses multiple indices, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will ask you to select
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2319 one. Then, all index entries will be sorted alphabetically and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2320 displayed in a special buffer, the @file{*Index*} buffer. From that
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2321 buffer you can check and edit each entry.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2322
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2323 The index can be restricted to the current section or the region. Then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2324 only entries in that part of the document will go into the compiled
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2325 index. To restrict to the current section, use a numeric prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2326 @samp{2}, thus press @kbd{C-u 2 C-c >}. To restrict to the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2327 region, make the region active and use a numeric prefix @samp{3} (press
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2328 @kbd{C-u 3 C-c >}). From within the @file{*Index*} buffer the
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2329 restriction can be moved from one section to the next by pressing the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2330 @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2331
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2332 One caveat: @b{Ref@TeX{}} finds the definition point of an index entry
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2333 by searching near the buffer position where it had found to macro during
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2334 scanning. If you have several identical index entries in the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2335 buffer and significant changes have shifted the entries around, you must
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2336 rescan the buffer to ensure the correspondence between the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2337 @file{*Index*} buffer and the definition locations. It is therefore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2338 advisable to rescan the document (with @kbd{r} or @kbd{C-u r})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2339 frequently while editing the index from the @file{*Index*}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2340 buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2341
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2342 @kindex ?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2343 Here is a list of special commands available in the @file{*Index*} buffer. A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2344 summary of this information is always available by pressing
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2345 @kbd{?}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2346
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2347 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2348 @tablesubheading{General}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2349 @item ?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2350 Display a summary of commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2351
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2352 @item 0-9, -
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2353 Prefix argument.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2354
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2355 @tablesubheading{Moving around}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2356 @item ! A..Z
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2357 Pressing any capital letter will jump to the corresponding section in
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2358 the @file{*Index*} buffer. The exclamation mark is special and jumps to
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2359 the first entries alphabetically sorted below @samp{A}. These are
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2360 usually non-alphanumeric characters.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2361 @item n
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2362 Go to next entry.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2363 @item p
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2364 Go to previous entry.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2365
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2366 @tablesubheading{Access to document locations}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2367 @item @key{SPC}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2368 Show the place in the document where this index entry is defined.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2369
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2370 @item @key{TAB}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2371 Go to the definition of the current index entry in another
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2372 window.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2373
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2374 @item @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2375 Go to the definition of the current index entry and hide the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2376 @file{*Index*} buffer window.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2377
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2378 @item f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2379 @vindex reftex-index-follow-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2380 @vindex reftex-revisit-to-follow
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2381 Toggle follow mode. When follow mode is active, the other window will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2382 always show the location corresponding to the line in the @file{*Index*}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2383 buffer at point. This is similar to pressing @key{SPC} after each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2384 cursor motion. The default for this flag can be set with the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2385 @code{reftex-index-follow-mode}. Note that only context in files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2386 already visited is shown. @b{Ref@TeX{}} will not visit a file just for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2387 follow mode. See, however, the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2388 @code{reftex-revisit-to-follow}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2389
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2390 @tablesubheading{Entry editing}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2391 @item e
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2392 Edit the current index entry. In the minibuffer, you can edit the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2393 index macro which defines this entry.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2394
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2395 @item C-k
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2396 Kill the index entry. Currently not implemented because I don't know
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2397 how to implement an @code{undo} function for this.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2398
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2399 @item *
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2400 Edit the @var{key} part of the entry. This is the initial part of the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2401 entry which determines the location of the entry in the index.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2402
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2403 @item |
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2404 Edit the @var{attribute} part of the entry. This is the part after the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2405 vertical bar. With @code{MakeIndex}, this part is an encapsulating
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2406 macro. With @code{xindy}, it is called @emph{attribute} and is a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2407 property of the index entry that can lead to special formatting. When
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2408 called with @kbd{C-u} prefix, kill the entire @var{attribute}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2409 part.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2410
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2411 @item @@
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2412 Edit the @var{visual} part of the entry. This is the part after the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2413 @samp{@@} which is used by @code{MakeIndex} to change the visual
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2414 appearance of the entry in the index. When called with @kbd{C-u}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2415 prefix, kill the entire @var{visual} part.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2416
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2417 @item (
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2418 Toggle the beginning of page range property @samp{|(} of the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2419 entry.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2420
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2421 @item )
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2422 Toggle the end of page range property @samp{|)} of the entry.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2423
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2424 @item _
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2425 Make the current entry a subentry. This command will prompt for the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2426 superordinate entry and insert it.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2427
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2428 @item ^
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2429 Remove the highest superordinate entry. If the current entry is a
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2430 subitem (@samp{aaa!bbb!ccc}), this function moves it up the hierarchy
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2431 (@samp{bbb!ccc}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2432
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2433 @tablesubheading{Exiting}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2434 @item q
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2435 Hide the @file{*Index*} buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2436
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2437 @item k
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2438 Kill the @file{*Index*} buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2439
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2440 @item C-c =
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2441 Switch to the Table of Contents buffer of this document.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2442
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2443 @tablesubheading{Controlling what gets displayed}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2444 @item c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2445 @vindex reftex-index-include-context
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2446 Toggle the display of short context in the @file{*Index*} buffer. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2447 default for this flag can be set with the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2448 @code{reftex-index-include-context}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2449
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2450 @item @}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2451 Restrict the index to a single document section. The corresponding
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2452 section number will be displayed in the @code{R<>} indicator in the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2453 mode line and in the header of the @file{*Index*} buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2454
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2455 @item @{
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2456 Widen the index to contain all entries of the document.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2457
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2458 @item <
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2459 When the index is currently restricted, move the restriction to the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2460 previous section.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2461
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2462 @item >
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2463 When the index is currently restricted, move the restriction to the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2464 next section.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2465
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2466 @tablesubheading{Updating the buffer}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2467 @item g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2468 Rebuild the @file{*Index*} buffer. This does @emph{not} rescan the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2469 document. However, it sorts the entries again, so that edited entries
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2470 will move to the correct position.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2471
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2472 @item r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2473 @vindex reftex-enable-partial-scans
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2474 Reparse the LaTeX document and rebuild the @file{*Index*} buffer. When
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2475 @code{reftex-enable-partial-scans} is non-nil, rescan only the file this
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2476 location is defined in, not the entire document.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2477
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2478 @item C-u r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2479 Reparse the @emph{entire} LaTeX document and rebuild the @file{*Index*}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2480 buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2481
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2482 @item s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2483 Switch to a different index (for documents with multiple
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2484 indices).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2485 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2486
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2487
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2488 @node Builtin Index Macros, Defining Index Macros, Displaying and Editing the Index, Index Support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2489 @section Builtin Index Macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2490 @cindex Builtin index macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2491 @cindex Index macros, builtin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2492 @vindex reftex-index-macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2493 @cindex @code{multind}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2494 @cindex @code{index}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2495 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{multind}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2496 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{index}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2497
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2498 @b{Ref@TeX{}} by default recognizes the @code{\index} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2499 @code{\glossary} macros which are defined in the LaTeX core. It has
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2500 also builtin support for the re-implementations of @code{\index}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2501 in the @file{multind} and @file{index} packages. However, since
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2502 the different definitions of the @code{\index} macro are incompatible,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2503 you will have to explicitly specify the index style used.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2504 @xref{Creating Index Entries}, for information on how to do that.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2505
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2506 @node Defining Index Macros, , Builtin Index Macros, Index Support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2507 @section Defining Index Macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2508 @cindex Defining Index Macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2509 @cindex Index macros, defining
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2510 @vindex reftex-index-macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2511
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2512 When writing a document with an index you will probably define
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2513 additional macros which make entries into the index.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2514 Let's look at an example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2515
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2516 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2517 \newcommand@{\ix@}[1]@{#1\index@{#1@}@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2518 \newcommand@{\nindex@}[1]@{\textit@{#1@}\index[name]@{#1@}@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2519 \newcommand@{\astobj@}[1]@{\index@{Astronomical Objects!#1@}@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2520 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2521
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2522 The first macro @code{\ix} typesets its argument in the text and places
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2523 it into the index. The second macro @code{\nindex} typesets its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2524 argument in the text and places it into a separate index with the tag
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2525 @samp{name}@footnote{We are using the syntax of the @file{index} package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2526 here.}. The last macro also places its argument into the index, but as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2527 subitems under the main index entry @samp{Astronomical Objects}. Here
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2528 is how to make @b{Ref@TeX{}} recognize and correctly interpret these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2529 macros, first with Emacs Lisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2530
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2531 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2532 (setq reftex-index-macros
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2533 '(("\\ix@{*@}" "idx" ?x "" nil nil)
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2534 ("\\nindex@{*@}" "name" ?n "" nil nil)
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2535 ("\\astobj@{*@}" "idx" ?o "Astronomical Objects!" nil t)))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2536 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2537
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2538 Note that the index tag is @samp{idx} for the main index, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2539 @samp{name} for the name index. @samp{idx} and @samp{glo} are reserved
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2540 for the default index and for the glossary.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2541
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2542 The character arguments @code{?x}, @code{?n}, and @code{?o} are for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2543 quick identification of these macros when @b{Ref@TeX{}} inserts new
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2544 index entries with @code{reftex-index}. These codes need to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2545 unique. @code{?i}, @code{?I}, and @code{?g} are reserved for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2546 @code{\index}, @code{\index*}, and @code{\glossary} macros,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2547 respectively.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2548
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2549 The following string is empty unless your macro adds a superordinate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2550 entry to the index key - this is the case for the @code{\astobj} macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2551
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2552 The next entry can be a hook function to exclude certain matches, it
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2553 almost always can be @code{nil}.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2554
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2555 The final element in the list indicates if the text being indexed needs
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2556 to be repeated outside the macro. For the normal index macros, this
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2557 should be @code{t}. Only if the macro typesets the entry in the text
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2558 (like @code{\ix} and @code{\nindex} in the example do), this should be
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2559 @code{nil}.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2560
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2561 To do the same thing with customize, you need to fill in the templates
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2562 like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2563
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2564 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2565 Repeat:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2566 [INS] [DEL] List:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2567 Macro with args: \ix@{*@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2568 Index Tag : [Value Menu] String: idx
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2569 Access Key : x
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2570 Key Prefix :
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2571 Exclusion hook : nil
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2572 Repeat Outside : [Toggle] off (nil)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2573 [INS] [DEL] List:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2574 Macro with args: \nindex@{*@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2575 Index Tag : [Value Menu] String: name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2576 Access Key : n
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2577 Key Prefix :
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2578 Exclusion hook : nil
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2579 Repeat Outside : [Toggle] off (nil)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2580 [INS] [DEL] List:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2581 Macro with args: \astobj@{*@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2582 Index Tag : [Value Menu] String: idx
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2583 Access Key : o
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2584 Key Prefix : Astronomical Objects!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2585 Exclusion hook : nil
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2586 Repeat Outside : [Toggle] on (non-nil)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2587 [INS]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2588 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2589
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2590 With the macro @code{\ix} defined, you may want to change the default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2591 macro used for indexing a text phrase (@pxref{Creating Index Entries}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2592 This would be done like this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2593
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2594 @lisp
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2595 (setq reftex-index-default-macro '(?x "idx"))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2596 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2597
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2598 which specifies that the macro identified with the character @code{?x} (the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2599 @code{\ix} macro) should be used for indexing phrases and words already
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2600 in the buffer with @kbd{C-c /} (@code{reftex-index-selection-or-word}).
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2601 The index tag is "idx".
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2602
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2603 @node Viewing Cross-References, RefTeXs Menu, Index Support, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2604 @chapter Viewing Cross--References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2605 @findex reftex-view-crossref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2606 @findex reftex-mouse-view-crossref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2607 @kindex C-c &
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
2608 @kindex S-mouse-2
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2609
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2610 @b{Ref@TeX{}} can display cross--referencing information. This means,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2611 if two document locations are linked, @b{Ref@TeX{}} can display the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2612 matching location(s) in another window. The @code{\label} and @code{\ref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2613 macros are one way of establishing such a link. Also, a @code{\cite}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2614 macro is linked to the corresponding @code{\bibitem} macro or a BibTeX
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2615 database entry.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2616
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2617 The feature is invoked by pressing @kbd{C-c &}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2618 (@code{reftex-view-crossref}) while point is on the @var{key} argument
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2619 of a macro involved in cross--referencing. You can also click with
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
2620 @kbd{S-mouse-2} on the macro argument. Here is what will happen for
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2621 individual classes of macros:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2622
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2623 @table @asis
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2624
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2625 @item @code{\ref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2626 @cindex @code{\ref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2627 Display the corresponding label definition. All usual
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2628 variants@footnote{all macros that start with @samp{ref} or end with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2629 @samp{ref} or @samp{refrange}} of the @code{\ref} macro are active for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2630 cross--reference display. This works also for labels defined in an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2631 external document when the current document refers to them through the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2632 @code{xr} interface (@pxref{xr (LaTeX package)}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2633
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2634 @item @code{\label}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2635 @cindex @code{\label}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2636 @vindex reftex-label-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2637 Display a document location which references this label. Pressing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2638 @kbd{C-c &} several times moves through the entire document and finds
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2639 all locations. Not only the @code{\label} macro but also other macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2640 with label arguments (as configured with @code{reftex-label-alist}) are
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2641 active for cross--reference display.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2642
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2643 @item @code{\cite}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2644 @cindex @code{\cite}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2645 Display the corresponding BibTeX database entry or @code{\bibitem}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2646 All usual variants@footnote{all macros that either start or end with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2647 @samp{cite}} of the @code{\cite} macro are active for cross--reference
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2648 display.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2649
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2650 @item @code{\bibitem}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2651 @cindex @code{\bibitem}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2652 Display a document location which cites this article. Pressing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2653 @kbd{C-c &} several times moves through the entire document and finds
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2654 all locations.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2655
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2656 @item BibTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2657 @cindex BibTeX buffer, viewing cite locations from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2658 @cindex Viewing cite locations from BibTeX buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2659 @kbd{C-c &} is also active in BibTeX buffers. All locations in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2660 document where the database entry at point is cited will be displayed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2661 On first use, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will prompt for a buffer which belongs to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2662 the document you want to search. Subsequent calls will use the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2663 document, until you break this link with a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2664 &}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2665
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2666 @item @code{\index}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2667 @cindex @code{\index}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2668 Display other locations in the document which are marked by an index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2669 macro with the same key argument. Along with the standard @code{\index}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2670 and @code{\glossary} macros, all macros configured in
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2671 @code{reftex-index-macros} will be recognized.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2672 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2673
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
2674 @vindex reftex-view-crossref-extra
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2675 While the display of cross referencing information for the above
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2676 mentioned macros is hard--coded, you can configure additional relations
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
2677 in the variable @code{reftex-view-crossref-extra}.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2678
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2679 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2680 @chapter All the Rest
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2681 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2682
39267
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2683 @node RefTeXs Menu, Key Bindings, Viewing Cross-References, Top
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2684 @section @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s Menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2685 @cindex RefTeXs Menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2686 @cindex Menu, in the menu bar
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2687
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2688 @b{Ref@TeX{}} installs a @code{Ref} menu in the menu bar on systems
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2689 which support this. From this menu you can access all of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2690 @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s commands and a few of its options. There is also a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2691 @code{Customize} submenu which can be used to access @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2692 entire set of options.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2693
39267
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2694 @node Key Bindings, Faces, RefTeXs Menu, Top
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2695 @section Default Key Bindings
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2696 @cindex Key Bindings, summary
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2697
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2698 Here is a summary of the available key bindings.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2699
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2700 @kindex C-c =
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
2701 @kindex C-c -
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2702 @kindex C-c (
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2703 @kindex C-c )
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2704 @kindex C-c [
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2705 @kindex C-c &
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
2706 @kindex S-mouse-2
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2707 @kindex C-c /
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2708 @kindex C-c \
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2709 @kindex C-c |
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2710 @kindex C-c <
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2711 @kindex C-c >
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2712 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2713 @kbd{C-c =} @code{reftex-toc}
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
2714 @kbd{C-c -} @code{reftex-toc-recenter}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2715 @kbd{C-c (} @code{reftex-label}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2716 @kbd{C-c )} @code{reftex-reference}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2717 @kbd{C-c [} @code{reftex-citation}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2718 @kbd{C-c &} @code{reftex-view-crossref}
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
2719 @kbd{S-mouse-2} @code{reftex-mouse-view-crossref}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2720 @kbd{C-c /} @code{reftex-index-selection-or-word}
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2721 @kbd{C-c \} @code{reftex-index-phrase-selection-or-word}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2722 @kbd{C-c |} @code{reftex-index-visit-phrases-buffer}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2723 @kbd{C-c <} @code{reftex-index}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2724 @kbd{C-c >} @code{reftex-display-index}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2725 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2726
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
2727 Note that the @kbd{S-mouse-2} binding is only provided if this key is
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2728 not already used by some other package. @b{Ref@TeX{}} will not override an
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2729 existing binding to @kbd{S-mouse-2}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2730
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2731 Personally, I also bind some functions in the users @kbd{C-c} map for
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2732 easier access.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2733
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2734 @c FIXME: Do we need bindings for the Index macros here as well?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2735 @c C-c i C-c I or so????
39267
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2736 @c How about key bindings for reftex-reset-mode and reftex-parse-document?
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2737 @kindex C-c t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2738 @kindex C-c l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2739 @kindex C-c r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2740 @kindex C-c c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2741 @kindex C-c v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2742 @kindex C-c s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2743 @kindex C-c g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2744 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2745 @kbd{C-c t} @code{reftex-toc}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2746 @kbd{C-c l} @code{reftex-label}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2747 @kbd{C-c r} @code{reftex-reference}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2748 @kbd{C-c c} @code{reftex-citation}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2749 @kbd{C-c v} @code{reftex-view-crossref}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2750 @kbd{C-c s} @code{reftex-search-document}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2751 @kbd{C-c g} @code{reftex-grep-document}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2752 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2753
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2754 @noindent These keys are reserved for the user, so I cannot bind them by
39267
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2755 default. If you want to have these key bindings available, set in your
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2756 @file{.emacs} file:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2757
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2758 @vindex reftex-extra-bindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2759 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2760 (setq reftex-extra-bindings t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2761 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2762
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2763 @vindex reftex-load-hook
39267
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2764 Changing and adding to @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s key bindings is best done in the hook
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2765 @code{reftex-load-hook}. For information on the keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2766 which should be used to add keys, see @ref{Keymaps and Hooks}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2767
39267
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
2768 @node Faces, AUCTeX, Key Bindings, Top
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2769 @section Faces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2770 @cindex Faces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2771
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2772 @b{Ref@TeX{}} uses faces when available to structure the selection and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2773 table of contents buffers. It does not create its own faces, but uses
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2774 the ones defined in @file{font-lock.el}. Therefore, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2775 use faces only when @code{font-lock} is loaded. This seems to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2776 reasonable because people who like faces will very likely have it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2777 loaded. If you wish to turn off fontification or change the involved
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2778 faces, see @ref{Options (Fontification)}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2779
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2780 @node Multifile Documents, Language Support, AUCTeX, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2781 @section Multifile Documents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2782 @cindex Multifile documents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2783 @cindex Documents, spread over files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2784
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2785 The following is relevant when working with documents spread over many
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2786 files:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2787
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2788 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2789 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2790 @b{Ref@TeX{}} has full support for multifile documents. You can edit parts of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2791 several (multifile) documents at the same time without conflicts.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2792 @b{Ref@TeX{}} provides functions to run @code{grep}, @code{search} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2793 @code{query-replace} on all files which are part of a multifile
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2794 document.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2795
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2796 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2797 @vindex tex-main-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2798 @vindex TeX-master
29772
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2799 All files belonging to a multifile document should define a File
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2800 Variable (@code{TeX-master} for AUCTeX or @code{tex-main-file} for the
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2801 standard Emacs LaTeX mode) containing the name of the master file. For
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2802 example, to set the file variable @code{TeX-master}, include something
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2803 like the following at the end of each TeX file:
29772
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2804
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2805 @example
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2806 %%% Local Variables: ***
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2807 %%% mode:latex ***
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2808 %%% TeX-master: "thesis.tex" ***
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2809 %%% End: ***
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2810 @end example
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2811
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2812 AUCTeX with the setting
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2813
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2814 @lisp
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2815 (setq-default TeX-master nil)
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2816 @end lisp
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2817
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2818 will actually ask you for each new file about the master file and insert
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2819 this comment automatically. For more details see the documentation of
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2820 the AUCTeX (@pxref{Multifile,,,auctex, The AUC TeX User Manual}), the
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2821 documentation about the Emacs (La)TeX mode (@pxref{TeX Print,,,emacs,
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
2822 The GNU Emacs Manual}) and the Emacs documentation on File Variables
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2823 (@pxref{File Variables,,,emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2824
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2825 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2826 The context of a label definition must be found in the same file as the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2827 label itself in order to be processed correctly by @b{Ref@TeX{}}. The only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2828 exception is that section labels referring to a section statement
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2829 outside the current file can still use that section title as
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2830 context.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2831 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2832
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2833 @node Language Support, Finding Files, Multifile Documents, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2834 @section Language Support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2835 @cindex Language support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2836
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2837 Some parts of @b{Ref@TeX{}} are language dependent. The default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2838 settings work well for English. If you are writing in a different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2839 language, the following hints may be useful:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2840
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2841 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2842 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2843 @vindex reftex-derive-label-parameters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2844 @vindex reftex-abbrev-parameters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2845 The mechanism to derive a label from context includes the abbreviation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2846 of words and omission of unimportant words. These mechanisms may have
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2847 to be changed for other languages. See the variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2848 @code{reftex-derive-label-parameters} and @code{reftex-abbrev-parameters}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2849
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2850 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2851 @vindex reftex-translate-to-ascii-function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2852 @vindex reftex-label-illegal-re
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2853 Also, when a label is derived from context, @b{Ref@TeX{}} clears the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2854 context string from non-ASCII characters in order to make a legal label.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2855 If there should ever be a version of @TeX{} which allows extended
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2856 characters @emph{in labels}, then we will have to look at the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2857 variables @code{reftex-translate-to-ascii-function} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2858 @code{reftex-label-illegal-re}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2859
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2860 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2861 When a label is referenced, @b{Ref@TeX{}} looks at the word before point
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2862 to guess which label type is required. These @emph{magic words} are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2863 different in every language. For an example of how to add magic words,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2864 see @ref{Adding Magic Words}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2865
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2866 @vindex reftex-multiref-punctuation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2867 @vindex reftex-cite-punctuation
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2868 @item
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2869 @b{Ref@TeX{}} inserts ``punctuation'' for multiple references and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2870 for the author list in citations. Some of this may be language
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2871 dependent. See the variables @code{reftex-multiref-punctuation} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2872 @code{reftex-cite-punctuation}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2873 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2874
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2875 @node Finding Files, Optimizations, Language Support, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2876 @section Finding Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2877 @cindex Finding files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2878
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2879 In order to find files included in a document via @code{\input} or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2880 @code{\include}, @b{Ref@TeX{}} searches all directories specified in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2881 environment variable @code{TEXINPUTS}. Similarly, it will search the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2882 path specified in the variables @code{BIBINPUTS} and @code{TEXBIB} for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2883 BibTeX database files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2884
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2885 When searching, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will also expand recursive path
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2886 definitions (directories ending in @samp{//} or @samp{!!}). But it will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2887 only search and expand directories @emph{explicitly} given in these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2888 variables. This may cause problems under the following circumstances:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2889
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2890 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2891 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2892 Most TeX system have a default search path for both TeX files and BibTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2893 files which is defined in some setup file. Usually this default path is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2894 for system files which @b{Ref@TeX{}} does not need to see. But if your
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2895 document needs TeX files or BibTeX database files in a directory only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2896 given in the default search path, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will fail to find them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2897 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2898 Some TeX systems do not use environment variables at all in order to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2899 specify the search path. Both default and user search path are then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2900 defined in setup files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2901 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2902
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2903 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2904 There are three ways to solve this problem:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2905
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2906 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2907 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2908 Specify all relevant directories explicitly in the environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2909 variables. If for some reason you don't want to mess with the default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2910 variables @code{TEXINPUTS} and @code{BIBINPUTS}, define your own
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2911 variables and configure @b{Ref@TeX{}} to use them instead:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2912
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2913 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2914 (setq reftex-texpath-environment-variables '("MYTEXINPUTS"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2915 (setq reftex-bibpath-environment-variables '("MYBIBINPUTS"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2916 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2917
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2918 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2919 Specify the full search path directly in @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s variables.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2920
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2921 @lisp
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2922 (setq reftex-texpath-environment-variables
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2923 '("./inp:/home/cd/tex//:/usr/local/tex//"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2924 (setq reftex-bibpath-environment-variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2925 '("/home/cd/tex/lit/"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2926 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2927
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2928 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2929 Some TeX systems provide stand--alone programs to do the file search just
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2930 like TeX and BibTeX. E.g. Thomas Esser's @code{teTeX} uses the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2931 @code{kpathsearch} library which provides the command @code{kpsewhich}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2932 to search for files. @b{Ref@TeX{}} can be configured to use this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2933 program. Note that the exact syntax of the @code{kpsewhich}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2934 command depends upon the version of that program.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2935
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2936 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2937 (setq reftex-use-external-file-finders t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2938 (setq reftex-external-file-finders
37038
528310f62c34 (Finding Files): Fix an example.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36509
diff changeset
2939 '(("tex" . "kpsewhich -format=.tex %f")
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2940 ("bib" . "kpsewhich -format=.bib %f")))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2941 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2942 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2943
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2944 @cindex Noweb files
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2945 @vindex reftex-file-extensions
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2946 @vindex TeX-file-extensions
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2947 Some people like to use RefTeX with noweb files, which usually have the
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2948 extension @file{.nw}. In order to deal with such files, the new
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2949 extension must be added to the list of valid extensions in the variable
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2950 @code{reftex-file-extensions}. When working with AUCTeX as major mode,
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2951 the new extension must also be known to AUCTeX via the variable
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2952 @code{TeX-file-extension}. For example:
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2953
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2954 @lisp
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2955 (setq reftex-file-extensions
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2956 '(("nw" "tex" ".tex" ".ltx") ("bib" ".bib")))
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2957 (setq TeX-file-extensions
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2958 '( "nw" "tex" "sty" "cls" "ltx" "texi" "texinfo"))
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2959 @end lisp
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
2960
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2961 @node Optimizations, Problems and Work-Arounds, Finding Files, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2962 @section Optimizations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2963 @cindex Optimizations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2964
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
2965 @b{Note added 2002. Computers have gotten a lot faster, so most of the
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
2966 optimizations discussed below will not be necessary on new machines. I
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
2967 am leaving this stuff in the manual for people who want to write thick
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
2968 books, where some of it still might be useful.}
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
2969
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2970 Implementing the principle of least surprises, the default settings of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2971 @b{Ref@TeX{}} ensure a safe ride for beginners and casual users. However,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2972 when using @b{Ref@TeX{}} for a large project and/or on a small computer,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
2973 there are ways to improve speed or memory usage.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2974
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2975 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2976 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2977 @b{Removing Lookup Buffers}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2978 @cindex Removing lookup buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2979 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will load other parts of a multifile document as well as BibTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2980 database files for lookup purposes. These buffers are kept, so that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2981 subsequent use of the same files is fast. If you can't afford keeping
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2982 these buffers around, and if you can live with a speed penalty, try
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2983
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2984 @vindex reftex-keep-temporary-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2985 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2986 (setq reftex-keep-temporary-buffers nil)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2987 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2988
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2989 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2990 @b{Partial Document Scans}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2991 @cindex Partial documents scans
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2992 @cindex Document scanning, partial
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2993 A @kbd{C-u} prefix on the major @b{Ref@TeX{}} commands @code{reftex-label}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2994 (@kbd{C-u C-c (}), @code{reftex-reference} (@kbd{C-u C-c )}),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2995 @code{reftex-citation} (@kbd{C-u C-c [}), @code{reftex-toc} (@kbd{C-u C-c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2996 =}), and @code{reftex-view-crossref} (@kbd{C-u C-c &}) initiates
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2997 re-parsing of the entire document in order to update the parsing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2998 information. For a large document this can be unnecessary, in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2999 particular if only one file has changed. @b{Ref@TeX{}} can be configured
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3000 to do partial scans instead of full ones. @kbd{C-u} re-parsing then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3001 does apply only to the current buffer and files included from it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3002 Likewise, the @kbd{r} key in both the label selection buffer and the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3003 table-of-contents buffer will only prompt scanning of the file in which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3004 the label or section macro near the cursor was defined. Re-parsing of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3005 the entire document is still available by using @kbd{C-u C-u} as a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3006 prefix, or the capital @kbd{R} key in the menus. To use this feature,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3007 try
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3008
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3009 @vindex reftex-enable-partial-scans
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3010 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3011 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3012 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3013
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3014 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3015 @b{Saving Parser Information}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3016 @cindex Saving parser information
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3017 @cindex Parse information, saving to a file
27195
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
3018 @vindex reftex-parse-file-extension
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3019 Even with partial scans enabled, @b{Ref@TeX{}} still has to make one full
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3020 scan, when you start working with a document. To avoid this, parsing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3021 information can be stored in a file. The file @file{MASTER.rel} is used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3022 for storing information about a document with master file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3023 @file{MASTER.tex}. It is written automatically when you kill a buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3024 in @code{reftex-mode} or when you exit Emacs. The information is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3025 restored when you begin working with a document in a new editing
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3026 session. To use this feature, put into @file{.emacs}:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3027
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3028 @vindex reftex-save-parse-info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3029 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3030 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3031 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3032
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3033 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3034 @b{Identifying label types by prefix}@*
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3035 @cindex Parse information, saving to a file
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3036 @vindex reftex-trust-label-prefix
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3037 @b{Ref@TeX{}} normally parses around each label to check in which
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3038 environment this label is located, in order to assign a label type to
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3039 the label. If your document contains thousands of labels, document
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3040 parsing will take considerable time. If you have been using label prefixes
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3041 like tab: and fn: consistently, you can tell @b{Ref@TeX{}} to get the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3042 label type directly from the prefix, without additional parsing. This
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3043 will be faster and also allow labels to end up in the correct category
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3044 if for some reason it is not possible to derive the correct type from
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3045 context. For example, to enable this feature for footnote and
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3046 equation labels, use
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3047
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3048 @lisp
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3049 (setq reftex-trust-label-prefix '("fn:" "eq:"))
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3050 @end lisp
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3051
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3052 @item
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3053 @b{Automatic Document Scans}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3054 @cindex Automatic document scans
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3055 @cindex Document scanning, automatic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3056 At rare occasions, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will automatically rescan a part of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3057 document. If this gets into your way, it can be turned off with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3058
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3059 @vindex reftex-allow-automatic-rescan
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3060 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3061 (setq reftex-allow-automatic-rescan nil)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3062 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3063
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3064 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will then occasionally annotate new labels in the selection
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3065 buffer, saying that their position in the label list in uncertain. A
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3066 manual document scan will fix this.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3067
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3068 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3069 @b{Multiple Selection Buffers}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3070 @cindex Multiple selection buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3071 @cindex Selection buffers, multiple
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3072 Normally, the selection buffer @file{*RefTeX Select*} is re-created for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3073 every selection process. In documents with very many labels this can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3074 take several seconds. @b{Ref@TeX{}} provides an option to create a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3075 separate selection buffer for each label type and to keep this buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3076 from one selection to the next. These buffers are updated automatically
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3077 only when a new label has been added in the buffers category with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3078 @code{reftex-label}. Updating the buffer takes as long as recreating it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3079 - so the time saving is limited to cases where no new labels of that
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3080 category have been added. To turn on this feature, use
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3081
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3082 @vindex reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3083 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3084 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3085 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3086
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3087 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3088 @cindex Selection buffers, updating
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3089 You can also inhibit the automatic updating entirely. Then the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3090 selection buffer will always pop up very fast, but may not contain the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3091 most recently defined labels. You can always update the buffer by hand,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3092 with the @kbd{g} key. To get this behavior, use instead
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3093
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3094 @vindex reftex-auto-update-selection-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3095 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3096 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3097 reftex-auto-update-selection-buffers nil)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3098 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3099 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3100
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3101 @need 2000
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3102 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3103 @b{As a summary}, here are the settings I recommend for heavy use of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3104 @b{Ref@TeX{}} with large documents:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3105
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3106 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3107 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3108 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3109 reftex-save-parse-info t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3110 reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3111 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3112 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3113
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3114 @node AUCTeX, Multifile Documents, Faces, Top
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3115 @section @w{AUC @TeX{}}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3116 @cindex @code{AUCTeX}, Emacs package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3117 @cindex Emacs packages, @code{AUCTeX}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3118
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3119 AUCTeX is without doubt the best major mode for editing TeX and LaTeX
29772
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
3120 files with Emacs (@pxref{Top,AUCTeX,,auctex, The AUCTeX User Manual}).
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3121 If AUCTeX is not part of your Emacs distribution, you can get
29772
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
3122 it@footnote{XEmacs 21.x users may want to install the corresponding
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3123 XEmacs package.} by ftp from the @value{AUCTEXSITE}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3124
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3125 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3126 * AUCTeX-RefTeX Interface:: How both packages work together
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3127 * Style Files:: AUCTeX's style files can support RefTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3128 * Bib-Cite:: Hypertext reading of a document
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3129 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3130
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3131 @node AUCTeX-RefTeX Interface, Style Files, , AUCTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3132 @subsection The AUC@TeX{}-@b{Ref@TeX{}} Interface
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3133
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3134 @b{Ref@TeX{}} contains code to interface with AUCTeX. When this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3135 interface is turned on, both packages will interact closely. Instead of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3136 using @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s commands directly, you can then also use them
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3137 indirectly as part of the AUCTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3138 environment@footnote{@b{Ref@TeX{}} 4.0 and AUCTeX 9.10c will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3139 needed for all of this to work. Parts of it work also with earlier
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3140 versions.}. The interface is turned on with
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3141
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3142 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3143 (setq reftex-plug-into-AUCTeX t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3144 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3145
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3146 If you need finer control about which parts of the interface are used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3147 and which not, read the docstring of the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3148 @code{reftex-plug-into-AUCTeX} or customize it with @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3149 customize-variable @key{RET} reftex-plug-into-AUCTeX @key{RET}}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3150
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3151 The following list describes the individual parts of the interface.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3152
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3153 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3154 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3155 @findex reftex-label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3156 @vindex LaTeX-label-function, @r{AUCTeX}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3157 @kindex C-c C-e
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3158 @kindex C-c C-s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3159 @findex LaTeX-section, @r{AUCTeX}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3160 @findex TeX-insert-macro, @r{AUCTeX}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3161 @b{AUCTeX calls @code{reftex-label} to insert labels}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3162 When a new section is created with @kbd{C-c C-s}, or a new environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3163 is inserted with @kbd{C-c C-e}, AUCTeX normally prompts for a label to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3164 go with it. With the interface, @code{reftex-label} is called instead.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3165 For example, if you type @kbd{C-c C-e equation @key{RET}}, AUCTeX and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3166 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will insert
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3167
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3168 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3169 \begin@{equation@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3170 \label@{eq:1@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3171
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3172 \end@{equation@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3173 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3174
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3175 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3176 without further prompts.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3177
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3178 Similarly, when you type @kbd{C-c C-s section @key{RET}}, @b{Ref@TeX{}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3179 will offer its default label which is derived from the section title.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3180
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3181 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3182 @b{AUCTeX tells @b{Ref@TeX{}} about new sections}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3183 When creating a new section with @kbd{C-c C-s}, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will not
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3184 have to rescan the buffer in order to see it.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3185
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3186 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3187 @findex reftex-arg-label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3188 @findex TeX-arg-label, @r{AUCTeX function}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3189 @findex reftex-arg-ref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3190 @findex TeX-arg-ref, @r{AUCTeX function}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3191 @findex reftex-arg-cite
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3192 @findex TeX-arg-cite, @r{AUCTeX function}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3193 @findex reftex-arg-index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3194 @findex TeX-arg-index, @r{AUCTeX function}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3195 @findex TeX-insert-macro, @r{AUCTeX function}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3196 @kindex C-c @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3197 @b{@b{Ref@TeX{}} supplies macro arguments}@* When you insert a macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3198 interactively with @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}, AUCTeX normally prompts for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3199 macro arguments. Internally, it uses the functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3200 @code{TeX-arg-label}, @code{TeX-arg-cite}, and @code{TeX-arg-index} to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3201 prompt for arguments which are labels, citation keys and index entries.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3202 The interface takes over these functions@footnote{@code{fset} is used to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3203 do this, which is not reversible. However, @b{Ref@TeX{}} implements the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3204 old functionality when you later decide to turn off the interface.} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3205 supplies the macro arguments with @b{Ref@TeX{}'s} mechanisms. For
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3206 example, when you type @kbd{C-c @key{RET} ref @key{RET}}, @b{Ref@TeX{}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3207 will supply its label selection process (@pxref{Referencing
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3208 Labels}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3209
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3210 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3211 @b{@b{Ref@TeX{}} tells AUCTeX about new labels, citation-- and index keys}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3212 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will add all newly created labels to AUCTeX's completion list.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3213 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3214
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3215 @node Style Files, Bib-Cite, AUCTeX-RefTeX Interface, AUCTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3216 @subsection Style Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3217 @cindex Style files, AUCTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3218 @findex TeX-add-style-hook, @r{AUCTeX}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3219 Style files are Emacs Lisp files which are evaluated by AUCTeX in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3220 association with the @code{\documentclass} and @code{\usepackage}
29772
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
3221 commands of a document (@pxref{Style Files,,,auctex}). Support for
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
3222 @b{Ref@TeX{}} in such a style file is useful when the LaTeX style
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
3223 defines macros or environments connected with labels, citations, or the
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
3224 index. Many style files (e.g. @file{amsmath.el} or @file{natbib.el})
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
3225 distributed with AUCTeX already support @b{Ref@TeX{}} in this
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3226 way.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3227
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3228 Before calling a @b{Ref@TeX{}} function, the style hook should always
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3229 test for the availability of the function, so that the style file will
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3230 also work for people who do not use @b{Ref@TeX{}}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3231
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3232 Additions made with style files in the way described below remain local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3233 to the current document. For example, if one package uses AMSTeX, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3234 style file will make @b{Ref@TeX{}} switch over to @code{\eqref}, but
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3235 this will not affect other documents.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3236
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3237 @findex reftex-add-label-environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3238 @findex reftex-add-to-label-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3239 A style hook may contain calls to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3240 @code{reftex-add-label-environments}@footnote{This used to be the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3241 function @code{reftex-add-to-label-alist} which is still available as an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3242 alias for compatibility.} which defines additions to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3243 @code{reftex-label-alist}. The argument taken by this function must have
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3244 the same format as @code{reftex-label-alist}. The @file{amsmath.el}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3245 style file of AUCTeX for example contains the following:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3246
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3247 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3248 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3249 (TeX-add-style-hook "amsmath"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3250 (lambda ()
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3251 (if (fboundp 'reftex-add-label-environments)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3252 (reftex-add-label-environments '(AMSTeX)))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3253 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3254 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3255
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3256 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3257 @findex LaTeX-add-environments, @r{AUCTeX}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3258 while a package @code{myprop} defining a @code{proposition} environment
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3259 with @code{\newtheorem} might use
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3260
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3261 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3262 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3263 (TeX-add-style-hook "myprop"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3264 (lambda ()
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3265 (LaTeX-add-environments '("proposition" LaTeX-env-label))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3266 (if (fboundp 'reftex-add-label-environments)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3267 (reftex-add-label-environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3268 '(("proposition" ?p "prop:" "~\\ref@{%s@}" t
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3269 ("Proposition" "Prop.") -3))))))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3270 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3271 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3272
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3273 @findex reftex-set-cite-format
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3274 Similarly, a style hook may contain a call to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3275 @code{reftex-set-cite-format} to set the citation format. The style
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3276 file @file{natbib.el} for the Natbib citation style does switch
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3277 @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s citation format like this:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3278
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3279 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3280 (TeX-add-style-hook "natbib"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3281 (lambda ()
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3282 (if (fboundp 'reftex-set-cite-format)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3283 (reftex-set-cite-format 'natbib))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3284 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3285
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3286 @findex reftex-add-index-macros
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3287 The hook may contain a call to @code{reftex-add-index-macros} to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3288 define additional @code{\index}-like macros. The argument must have
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3289 the same format as @code{reftex-index-macros}. It may be a symbol, to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3290 trigger support for one of the builtin index packages. For example,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3291 the style @file{multind.el} contains
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3292
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3293 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3294 (TeX-add-style-hook "multind"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3295 (lambda ()
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3296 (and (fboundp 'reftex-add-index-macros)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3297 (reftex-add-index-macros '(multind)))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3298 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3299
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3300 If you have your own package @file{myindex} which defines the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3301 following macros to be used with the LaTeX @file{index.sty} file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3302 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3303 \newcommand@{\molec@}[1]@{#1\index@{Molecules!#1@}@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3304 \newcommand@{\aindex@}[1]@{#1\index[author]@{#1@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3305 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3306
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3307 you could write this in the style file @file{myindex.el}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3308
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3309 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3310 (TeX-add-style-hook "myindex"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3311 (lambda ()
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3312 (TeX-add-symbols
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3313 '("molec" TeX-arg-index)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3314 '("aindex" TeX-arg-index))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3315 (if (fboundp 'reftex-add-index-macros)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3316 (reftex-add-index-macros
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3317 '(("molec@{*@}" "idx" ?m "Molecules!" nil nil)
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3318 ("aindex@{*@}" "author" ?a "" nil nil))))))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3319 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3320
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3321 @findex reftex-add-section-levels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3322 Finally the hook may contain a call to @code{reftex-add-section-levels}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3323 to define additional section statements. For example, the FoilTeX class
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3324 has just two headers, @code{\foilhead} and @code{\rotatefoilhead}. Here
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3325 is a style file @file{foils.el} that will inform @b{Ref@TeX{}} about these:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3326
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3327 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3328 (TeX-add-style-hook "foils"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3329 (lambda ()
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3330 (if (fboundp 'reftex-add-section-levels)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3331 (reftex-add-section-levels '(("foilhead" . 3)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3332 ("rotatefoilhead" . 3))))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3333 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3334
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3335 @node Bib-Cite, , Style Files, AUCTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3336 @subsection Bib-Cite
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3337 @cindex @code{bib-cite}, Emacs package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3338 @cindex Emacs packages, @code{bib-cite}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3339
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3340 Once you have written a document with labels, references and citations,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3341 it can be nice to read it like a hypertext document. @b{Ref@TeX{}} has
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3342 support for that: @code{reftex-view-crossref} (bound to @kbd{C-c
37999
8e7df927fd92 Updated to version 4.16
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 37404
diff changeset
3343 &}), @code{reftex-mouse-view-crossref} (bound to @kbd{S-mouse-2}), and
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3344 @code{reftex-search-document}. A somewhat fancier interface with mouse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3345 highlighting is provided (among other things) by Peter S. Galbraith's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3346 @file{bib-cite.el}. There is some overlap in the functionalities of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3347 Bib-cite and @b{Ref@TeX{}}. Bib-cite.el comes bundled with
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3348 AUCTeX.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3349
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3350 Bib-cite version 3.06 and later can be configured so that bib-cite's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3351 mouse functions use @b{Ref@TeX{}} for displaying references and citations.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3352 This can be useful in particular when working with the LaTeX @code{xr}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3353 package or with an explicit @code{thebibliography} environment (rather
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3354 than BibTeX). Bib-cite cannot handle those, but @b{Ref@TeX{}} does. To
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3355 make use of this feature, try
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3356
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3357 @vindex bib-cite-use-reftex-view-crossref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3358 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3359 (setq bib-cite-use-reftex-view-crossref t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3360 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3361
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3362 @page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3363 @node Problems and Work-Arounds, Imprint, Optimizations, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3364 @section Problems and Work-arounds
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3365 @cindex Problems and work-arounds
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3366
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3367 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3368 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3369 @b{LaTeX commands}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3370 @cindex LaTeX commands, not found
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3371 @code{\input}, @code{\include}, and @code{\section} (etc.) statements
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3372 have to be first on a line (except for white space).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3373
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3374 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3375 @b{Commented regions}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3376 @cindex Labels, commented out
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3377 @b{Ref@TeX{}} sees also labels in regions commented out and will refuse to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3378 make duplicates of such labels. This is considered to be a feature.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3379
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3380 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3381 @b{Wrong section numbers}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3382 @cindex Section numbers, wrong
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3383 @vindex reftex-enable-partial-scans
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3384 When using partial scans (@code{reftex-enable-partial-scans}), the section
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3385 numbers in the table of contents may eventually become wrong. A full
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3386 scan will fix this.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3387
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3388 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3389 @b{Local settings}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3390 @cindex Settings, local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3391 @findex reftex-add-label-environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3392 @findex reftex-set-cite-format
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3393 @findex reftex-add-section-levels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3394 The label environment definitions in @code{reftex-label-alist} are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3395 global and apply to all documents. If you need to make definitions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3396 local to a document, because they would interfere with settings in other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3397 documents, you should use AUCTeX and set up style files with calls to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3398 @code{reftex-add-label-environments}, @code{reftex-set-cite-format},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3399 @code{reftex-add-index-macros}, and @code{reftex-add-section-levels}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3400 Settings made with these functions remain local to the current
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3401 document. @xref{AUCTeX}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3402
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3403 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3404 @b{Funny display in selection buffer}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3405 @cindex @code{x-symbol}, Emacs package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3406 @cindex Emacs packages, @code{x-symbol}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3407 @cindex @code{isotex}, Emacs package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3408 @cindex Emacs packages, @code{isotex}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3409 @cindex @code{iso-cvt}, Emacs package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3410 @cindex Emacs packages, @code{iso-cvt}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3411 When using packages which make the buffer representation of a file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3412 different from its disk representation (e.g. x-symbol, isotex,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3413 iso-cvt) you may find that @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s parsing information sometimes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3414 reflects the disk state of a file. This happens only in @emph{unvisited}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3415 parts of a multifile document, because @b{Ref@TeX{}} visits these files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3416 literally for speed reasons. Then both short context and section
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3417 headings may look different from what you usually see on your screen.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3418 In rare cases @code{reftex-toc} may have problems to jump to an affected
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3419 section heading. There are three possible ways to deal with
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3420 this:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3421 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3422 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3423 @vindex reftex-keep-temporary-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3424 @code{(setq reftex-keep-temporary-buffers t)}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3425 This implies that @b{Ref@TeX{}} will load all parts of a multifile
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3426 document into Emacs (i.e. there won't be any temporary buffers).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3427 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3428 @vindex reftex-initialize-temporary-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3429 @code{(setq reftex-initialize-temporary-buffers t)}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3430 This means full initialization of temporary buffers. It involves
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3431 a penalty when the same unvisited file is used for lookup often.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3432 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3433 Set @code{reftex-initialize-temporary-buffers} to a list of hook
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3434 functions doing a minimal initialization.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3435 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3436 @vindex reftex-refontify-context
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3437 See also the variable @code{reftex-refontify-context}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3438
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3439 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3440 @b{Labels as arguments to \begin}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3441 @cindex @code{pf}, LaTeX package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3442 @cindex LaTeX packages, @code{pf}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3443 Some packages use an additional argument to a @code{\begin} macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3444 to specify a label. E.g. Lamport's @file{pf.sty} uses both
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3445 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3446 \step@{@var{label}@}@{@var{claim}@} and \begin@{step+@}@{@var{label}@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3447 @var{claim}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3448 \end@{step+@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3449 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3450
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3451 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3452 We need to trick @b{Ref@TeX{}} into swallowing this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3453
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3454 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3455 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3456 ;; Configuration for Lamport's pf.sty
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3457 (setq reftex-label-alist
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3458 '(("\\step@{*@}@{@}" ?p "st:" "~\\stepref@{%s@}" 2 ("Step" "St."))
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3459 ("\\begin@{step+@}@{*@}" ?p "st:" "~\\stepref@{%s@}" 1000)))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3460 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3461 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3462
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3463 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3464 The first line is just a normal configuration for a macro. For the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3465 @code{step+} environment we actually tell @b{Ref@TeX{}} to look for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3466 @emph{macro} @samp{\begin@{step+@}} and interpret the @emph{first}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3467 argument (which really is a second argument to the macro @code{\begin})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3468 as a label of type @code{?p}. Argument count for this macro starts only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3469 after the @samp{@{step+@}}, also when specifying how to get
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3470 context.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3471
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3472 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3473 @b{Idle timers in XEmacs}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3474 @cindex Idle timer restart
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3475 @vindex reftex-use-itimer-in-xemacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3476 In XEmacs, idle timer restart does not work reliably after fast
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3477 keystrokes. Therefore @b{Ref@TeX{}} currently uses the post command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3478 hook to start the timer used for automatic crossref information. When
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3479 this bug gets fixed, a real idle timer can be requested with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3480 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3481 (setq reftex-use-itimer-in-xemacs t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3482 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3483
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3484 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3485 @b{Viper mode}@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3486 @cindex Viper mode
39267
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
3487 @cindex Key bindings, problems with Viper mode
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3488 @findex viper-harness-minor-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3489 With @i{Viper} mode prior to Vipers version 3.01, you need to protect
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3490 @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s keymaps with
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3491
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3492 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3493 (viper-harness-minor-mode "reftex")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3494 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3495
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3496 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3497
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3498 @page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3499 @node Imprint, Commands, Problems and Work-Arounds, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3500 @section Imprint
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3501 @cindex Imprint
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3502 @cindex Maintainer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3503 @cindex Acknowledgments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3504 @cindex Thanks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3505 @cindex Bug reports
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3506 @cindex @code{http}, @b{Ref@TeX{}} home page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3507 @cindex @code{ftp}, @b{Ref@TeX{}} site
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3508
58872
6233bef879d8 (Imprint): Remove erroneous @value's.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 57912
diff changeset
3509 @b{Ref@TeX{}} was written by @i{Carsten Dominik}
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3510 @email{dominik@@science.uva.nl}, with contributions by @i{Stephen
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3511 Eglen}. @b{Ref@TeX{}} is currently maintained by
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3512
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3513 @noindent
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3514 Carsten Dominik <dominik@@science.uva.nl>
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3515
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3516 If you have questions about @b{Ref@TeX{}}, there are several Usenet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3517 groups which have competent readers: @code{comp.emacs},
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3518 @code{gnu.emacs.help}, @code{comp.emacs.xemacs}, @code{comp.text.tex},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3519 @code{de.comp.text.tex}. You can also write directly to the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3520 maintainer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3521
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3522 If you find a bug in @b{Ref@TeX{}} or its documentation, or if you want
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3523 to contribute code or ideas, please @value{MAINTAINERCONTACT}. Remember
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3524 to provide all necessary information such as version numbers of Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3525 and @b{Ref@TeX{}}, and the relevant part of your configuration in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3526 @file{.emacs}. When reporting a bug which throws an exception, please
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3527 include a backtrace if you know how to produce one.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3528
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3529 @b{Ref@TeX{}} is bundled and pre-installed with Emacs since version 20.2.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3530 It was also bundled and pre-installed with XEmacs 19.16--20.x. XEmacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3531 21.x users want to install the corresponding plugin package which is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3532 available from the @value{XEMACSFTP}. See the XEmacs 21.x
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3533 documentation on package installation for details.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3534
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3535 Users of earlier Emacs distributions (including Emacs 19) can get a
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3536 @b{Ref@TeX{}} distribution from the @value{MAINTAINERSITE}. Note that
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3537 the Emacs 19 version supports many but not all features described in
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3538 this manual.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3539
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3540 Thanks to the people on the Net who have used @b{Ref@TeX{}} and helped
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3541 developing it with their reports. In particular thanks to @i{Fran
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3542 Burstall, Alastair Burt, Lars Clausen, Soren Dayton, Stephen Eglen, Karl
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3543 Eichwalder, Erik Frisk, Peter Galbraith, Kai Grossjohann, Frank Harrell,
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3544 Peter Heslin, Stephan Heuel, Alan Ho, Lute Kamstra, Dieter Kraft, David
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3545 Kastrup, Adrian Lanz, Rory Molinari, Stefan Monnier, Laurent Mugnier,
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3546 Sudeep Kumar Palat, Daniel Polani, Alan Shutko, Robin Socha, Richard
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3547 Stanton, Allan Strand, Jan Vroonhof, Christoph Wedler, Alan Williams,
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3548 Roland Winkler, Hans-Christoph Wirth, Eli Zaretskii}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3549
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3550 The @code{view-crossref} feature was inspired by @i{Peter Galbraith's}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3551 @file{bib-cite.el}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3552
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3553 Finally thanks to @i{Uwe Bolick} who first got me interested in
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3554 supporting LaTeX labels and references with an editor (which was
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3555 MicroEmacs at the time).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3556
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3557 @node Commands, Options, Imprint, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3558 @chapter Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3559 @cindex Commands, list of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3560
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3561 Here is a summary of @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s commands which can be executed from
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3562 LaTeX files. Command which are executed from the special buffers are
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3563 not described here. All commands are available from the @code{Ref}
39267
a8c0a02f6129 Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38003
diff changeset
3564 menu. See @xref{Key Bindings}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3565
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3566 @deffn Command reftex-toc
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3567 Show the table of contents for the current document. When called with
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3568 one ore two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, rescan the document first.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3569 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3570
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3571 @deffn Command reftex-label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3572 Insert a unique label. With one or two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, enforce
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3573 document rescan first.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3574 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3575
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3576 @deffn Command reftex-reference
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3577 Start a selection process to select a label, and insert a reference to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3578 it. With one or two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, enforce document rescan first.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3579 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3580
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3581 @deffn Command reftex-citation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3582 Make a citation using BibTeX database files. After prompting for a regular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3583 expression, scans the buffers with BibTeX entries (taken from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3584 @code{\bibliography} command or a @code{thebibliography} environment)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3585 and offers the matching entries for selection. The selected entry is
46918
82d113655734 Minor spelling and grammar corrections.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 46684
diff changeset
3586 formatted according to @code{reftex-cite-format} and inserted into the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3587 buffer. @*
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3588 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefixe, prompt for optional arguments in
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3589 cite macros. When called with a numeric prefix, make that many citations.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3590 When called with point inside the braces of a @code{\cite} command, it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3591 will add another key, ignoring the value of
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3592 @code{reftex-cite-format}. @*
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3593 The regular expression uses an expanded syntax: @samp{&&} is interpreted
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3594 as @code{and}. Thus, @samp{aaaa&&bbb} matches entries which contain
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3595 both @samp{aaaa} and @samp{bbb}. While entering the regexp, completion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3596 on knows citation keys is possible. @samp{=} is a good regular
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3597 expression to match all entries in all files.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3598 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3599
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3600 @deffn Command reftex-index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3601 Query for an index macro and insert it along with its arguments. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3602 index macros available are those defined in @code{reftex-index-macro} or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3603 by a call to @code{reftex-add-index-macros}, typically from an AUCTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3604 style file. @b{Ref@TeX{}} provides completion for the index tag and the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3605 index key, and will prompt for other arguments.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3606 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3607
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3608 @deffn Command reftex-index-selection-or-word
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3609 Put current selection or the word near point into the default index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3610 macro. This uses the information in @code{reftex-index-default-macro}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3611 to make an index entry. The phrase indexed is the current selection or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3612 the word near point. When called with one @kbd{C-u} prefix, let the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3613 user have a chance to edit the index entry. When called with 2
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3614 @kbd{C-u} as prefix, also ask for the index macro and other stuff. When
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3615 called inside TeX math mode as determined by the @file{texmathp.el}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3616 library which is part of AUCTeX, the string is first processed with the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3617 @code{reftex-index-math-format}, which see.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3618 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3619
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3620 @deffn Command reftex-index-phrase-selection-or-word
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3621 Add current selection or the word at point to the phrases buffer.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3622 When you are in transient-mark-mode and the region is active, the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3623 selection will be used - otherwise the word at point.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3624 You get a chance to edit the entry in the phrases buffer - to save the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3625 buffer and return to the LaTeX document, finish with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3626 @end deffn
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3627
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3628 @deffn Command reftex-index-visit-phrases-buffer
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3629 Switch to the phrases buffer, initialize if empty.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3630 @end deffn
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3631
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3632 @deffn Command reftex-index-phrases-apply-to-region
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3633 Index all index phrases in the current region.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3634 This works exactly like global indexing from the index phrases buffer,
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3635 but operation is restricted to the current region.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3636 @end deffn
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3637
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3638 @deffn Command reftex-display-index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3639 Display a buffer with an index compiled from the current document.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3640 When the document has multiple indices, first prompts for the correct one.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3641 When index support is turned off, offer to turn it on.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3642 With one or two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, rescan document first.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3643 With prefix 2, restrict index to current document section.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3644 With prefix 3, restrict index to active region.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3645 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3646
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3647 @deffn Command reftex-view-crossref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3648 View cross reference of macro at point. Point must be on the @var{key}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3649 argument. Works with the macros @code{\label}, @code{\ref},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3650 @code{\cite}, @code{\bibitem}, @code{\index} and many derivatives of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3651 these. Where it makes sense, subsequent calls show additional
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3652 locations. See also the variable @code{reftex-view-crossref-extra} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3653 the command @code{reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex}. With one or two
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3654 @kbd{C-u} prefixes, enforce rescanning of the document. With argument
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3655 2, select the window showing the cross reference.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3656 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3657
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3658 @deffn Command reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3659 View location in a LaTeX document which cites the BibTeX entry at point.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3660 Since BibTeX files can be used by many LaTeX documents, this function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3661 prompts upon first use for a buffer in @b{Ref@TeX{}} mode. To reset this
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3662 link to a document, call the function with a prefix arg. Calling
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3663 this function several times find successive citation locations.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3664 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3665
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3666 @deffn Command reftex-create-tags-file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3667 Create TAGS file by running @code{etags} on the current document. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3668 TAGS file is also immediately visited with
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3669 @code{visit-tags-table}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3670 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3671
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3672 @deffn Command reftex-grep-document
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3673 Run grep query through all files related to this document.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3674 With prefix arg, force to rescan document.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3675 No active TAGS table is required.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3676 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3677
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3678 @deffn Command reftex-search-document
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3679 Regexp search through all files of the current document.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3680 Starts always in the master file. Stops when a match is found.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3681 No active TAGS table is required.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3682 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3683
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3684 @deffn Command reftex-query-replace-document
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3685 Run a query-replace-regexp of @var{from} with @var{to} over the entire
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3686 document. With prefix arg, replace only word-delimited matches. No
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3687 active TAGS table is required.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3688 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3689
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3690 @deffn Command reftex-goto-label
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3691 Prompt for a label (with completion) and jump to the location of this
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3692 label. Optional prefix argument @var{other-window} goes to the label in
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3693 another window.
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3694 @end deffn
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3695
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3696
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3697 @deffn Command reftex-change-label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3698 Query replace @var{from} with @var{to} in all @code{\label} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3699 @code{\ref} commands. Works on the entire multifile document. No
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3700 active TAGS table is required.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3701 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3702
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3703 @deffn Command reftex-renumber-simple-labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3704 Renumber all simple labels in the document to make them sequentially.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3705 Simple labels are the ones created by RefTeX, consisting only of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3706 prefix and a number. After the command completes, all these labels will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3707 have sequential numbers throughout the document. Any references to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3708 labels will be changed as well. For this, @b{Ref@TeX{}} looks at the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3709 arguments of any macros which either start or end with the string
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3710 @samp{ref}. This command should be used with care, in particular in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3711 multifile documents. You should not use it if another document refers
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3712 to this one with the @code{xr} package.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3713 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3714
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3715 @deffn Command reftex-find-duplicate-labels
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3716 Produce a list of all duplicate labels in the document.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3717 @end deffn
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3718
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3719 @deffn Command reftex-create-bibtex-file
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3720 Create a new BibTeX database file with all entries referenced in document.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3721 The command prompts for a filename and writes the collected entries to
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3722 that file. Only entries referenced in the current document with
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3723 any @code{\cite}-like macros are used.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3724 The sequence in the new file is the same as it was in the old database.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3725 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3726
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3727 @deffn Command reftex-customize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3728 Run the customize browser on the @b{Ref@TeX{}} group.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3729 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3730 @deffn Command reftex-show-commentary
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3731 Show the commentary section from @file{reftex.el}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3732 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3733 @deffn Command reftex-info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3734 Run info on the top @b{Ref@TeX{}} node.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3735 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3736 @deffn Command reftex-parse-document
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3737 Parse the entire document in order to update the parsing information.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3738 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3739 @deffn Command reftex-reset-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3740 Enforce rebuilding of several internal lists and variables. Also
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3741 removes the parse file associated with the current document.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3742 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3743
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3744 @node Options, Keymaps and Hooks, Commands, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3745 @chapter Options, Keymaps, Hooks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3746 @cindex Options, list of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3747
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3748 Here is a complete list of @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s configuration variables. All
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3749 variables have customize support - so if you are not familiar with Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3750 Lisp (and even if you are) you might find it more comfortable to use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3751 @code{customize} to look at and change these variables. @kbd{M-x
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3752 reftex-customize} will get you there.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3753
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3754 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3755 * Options (Table of Contents)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3756 * Options (Defining Label Environments)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3757 * Options (Creating Labels)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3758 * Options (Referencing Labels)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3759 * Options (Creating Citations)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3760 * Options (Index Support)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3761 * Options (Viewing Cross-References)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3762 * Options (Finding Files)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3763 * Options (Optimizations)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3764 * Options (Fontification)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3765 * Options (Misc)::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3766 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3767
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3768 @node Options (Table of Contents), Options (Defining Label Environments), , Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3769 @section Table of Contents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3770 @cindex Options, table of contents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3771 @cindex Table of contents, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3772
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3773 @defopt reftex-include-file-commands
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3774 List of LaTeX commands which input another file.
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3775 The file name is expected after the command, either in braces or separated
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3776 by whitespace.
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3777 @end defopt
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3778
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3779 @defopt reftex-max-section-depth
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3780 Maximum depth of section levels in document structure.
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3781 Standard LaTeX needs 7, default is 12.
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3782 @end defopt
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3783
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3784 @defopt reftex-section-levels
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3785 Commands and levels used for defining sections in the document. The
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3786 @code{car} of each cons cell is the name of the section macro. The
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3787 @code{cdr} is a number indicating its level. A negative level means the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3788 same as the positive value, but the section will never get a number.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3789 The @code{cdr} may also be a function which then has to return the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3790 level. This list is also used for promotion and demption of sectioning
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3791 commands. If you are using a document class which has several sets of
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3792 sectioning commands, promotion only works correctly if this list is
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3793 sorted first by set, then within each set by level. The promotion
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3794 commands always select the nearest entry with the correct new level.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3795
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3796 @end defopt
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3797
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3798 @defopt reftex-toc-max-level
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3799 The maximum level of toc entries which will be included in the TOC.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3800 Section headings with a bigger level will be ignored. In RefTeX,
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3801 chapters are level 1, sections level 2 etc. This variable can be
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3802 changed from within the @file{*toc*} buffer with the @kbd{t} key.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3803 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3804
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3805 @defopt reftex-part-resets-chapter
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3806 Non-@code{nil} means, @code{\part} is like any other sectioning command.
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3807 This means, part numbers will be included in the numbering of chapters, and
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3808 chapter counters will be reset for each part.
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3809 When @code{nil} (the default), parts are special, do not reset the
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3810 chapter counter and also do not show up in chapter numbers.
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3811 @end defopt
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3812
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3813 @defopt reftex-auto-recenter-toc
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3814 Non-@code{nil} means, turn automatic recentering of @file{*TOC*} window on.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3815 When active, the @file{*TOC*} window will always show the section you
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3816 are currently working in. Recentering happens whenever Emacs is idle for
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3817 more than @code{reftex-idle-time} seconds.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3818
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3819 Value @code{t} means, turn on immediately when RefTeX gets started. Then,
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3820 recentering will work for any toc window created during the session.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3821
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3822 Value @code{frame} (the default) means, turn automatic recentering on
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3823 only while the dedicated TOC frame does exist, and do the recentering
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3824 only in that frame. So when creating that frame (with @kbd{d} key in an
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3825 ordinary TOC window), the automatic recentering is turned on. When the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3826 frame gets destroyed, automatic recentering is turned off again.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3827
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3828 This feature can be turned on and off from the menu
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3829 (Ref->Options).
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3830 @end defopt
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
3831
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3832 @defopt reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3833 Non-@code{nil} means, create TOC window by splitting window
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3834 horizontally. The default is to split vertically.
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3835 @end defopt
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3836
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3837 @defopt reftex-toc-split-windows-fraction
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3838 Fraction of the width or height of the frame to be used for TOC window.
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3839 @end defopt
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3840
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3841 @defopt reftex-toc-keep-other-windows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3842 Non-@code{nil} means, split the selected window to display the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3843 @file{*toc*} buffer. This helps to keep the window configuration, but
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3844 makes the @file{*toc*} small. When @code{nil}, all other windows except
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3845 the selected one will be deleted, so that the @file{*toc*} window fills
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3846 half the frame.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3847 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3848
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3849 @defopt reftex-toc-include-file-boundaries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3850 Non-@code{nil} means, include file boundaries in @file{*toc*} buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3851 This flag can be toggled from within the @file{*toc*} buffer with the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3852 @kbd{i} key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3853 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3854
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3855 @defopt reftex-toc-include-labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3856 Non-@code{nil} means, include labels in @file{*toc*} buffer. This flag
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3857 can be toggled from within the @file{*toc*} buffer with the @kbd{l}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3858 key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3859 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3860
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3861 @defopt reftex-toc-include-index-entries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3862 Non-@code{nil} means, include index entries in @file{*toc*} buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3863 This flag can be toggled from within the @file{*toc*} buffer with the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3864 @kbd{i} key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3865 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3866
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3867 @defopt reftex-toc-include-context
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3868 Non-@code{nil} means, include context with labels in the @file{*toc*}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3869 buffer. Context will only be shown if the labels are visible as well.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3870 This flag can be toggled from within the @file{*toc*} buffer with the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3871 @kbd{c} key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3872 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3873
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3874 @defopt reftex-toc-follow-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3875 Non-@code{nil} means, point in @file{*toc*} buffer (the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3876 table-of-contents buffer) will cause other window to follow. The other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3877 window will show the corresponding part of the document. This flag can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3878 be toggled from within the @file{*toc*} buffer with the @kbd{f}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3879 key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3880 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3881
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3882 @deffn {Normal Hook} reftex-toc-mode-hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3883 Normal hook which is run when a @file{*toc*} buffer is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3884 created.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3885 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3886
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3887 @deffn Keymap reftex-toc-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3888 The keymap which is active in the @file{*toc*} buffer.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3889 (@pxref{Table of Contents}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3890 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3891
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3892 @node Options (Defining Label Environments), Options (Creating Labels), Options (Table of Contents), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3893 @section Defining Label Environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3894 @cindex Options, defining label environments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3895 @cindex Defining label environments, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3896
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3897 @defopt reftex-default-label-alist-entries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3898 Default label alist specifications. It is a list of symbols with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3899 associations in the constant @code{reftex-label-alist-builtin}.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3900 @code{LaTeX} should always be the last entry.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3901 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3902
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3903 @defopt reftex-label-alist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3904 Set this variable to define additions and changes to the defaults in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3905 @code{reftex-default-label-alist-entries}. The only things you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3906 @emph{must not} change is that @code{?s} is the type indicator for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3907 section labels, and @key{SPC} for the @code{any} label type. These are
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3908 hard-coded at other places in the code.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3909
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3910 The value of the variable must be a list of items. Each item is a list
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3911 itself and has the following structure:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3912
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3913 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3914 (@var{env-or-macro} @var{type-key} @var{label-prefix} @var{reference-format}
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3915 @var{context-method} (@var{magic-word} ... ) @var{toc-level})
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3916 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3917
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3918 Each list entry describes either an environment carrying a counter for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3919 use with @code{\label} and @code{\ref}, or a LaTeX macro defining a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3920 label as (or inside) one of its arguments. The elements of each list
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3921 entry are:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3922
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3923 @table @asis
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3924 @item @var{env-or-macro}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3925 Name of the environment (like @samp{table}) or macro (like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3926 @samp{\myfig}). For macros, indicate the arguments, as in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3927 @samp{\myfig[]@{@}@{@}@{*@}@{@}}. Use square brackets for optional
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3928 arguments, a star to mark the label argument, if any. The macro does
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3929 not have to have a label argument - you could also use
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3930 @samp{\label@{...@}} inside one of its arguments.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3931
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3932 Special names: @code{section} for section labels, @code{any} to define a
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3933 group which contains all labels.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3934
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3935 This may also be a function to do local parsing and identify point to be
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
3936 in a non-standard label environment. The function must take an
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3937 argument @var{bound} and limit backward searches to this value. It
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3938 should return either nil or a cons cell @code{(@var{function}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3939 . @var{position})} with the function symbol and the position where the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3940 special environment starts. See the Info documentation for an
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3941 example.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3942
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3943 Finally this may also be @code{nil} if the entry is only meant to change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3944 some settings associated with the type indicator character (see
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3945 below).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3946
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3947 @item @var{type-key}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3948 Type indicator character, like @code{?t}, must be a printable ASCII
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3949 character. The type indicator is a single character which defines a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3950 label type. Any label inside the environment or macro is assumed to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3951 belong to this type. The same character may occur several times in this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3952 list, to cover cases in which different environments carry the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3953 label type (like @code{equation} and @code{eqnarray}). If the type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3954 indicator is @code{nil} and the macro has a label argument @samp{@{*@}},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3955 the macro defines neutral labels just like @code{\label}. In this case
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3956 the reminder of this entry is ignored.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3957
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3958 @item @var{label-prefix}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3959 Label prefix string, like @samp{tab:}. The prefix is a short string
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3960 used as the start of a label. It may be the empty string. The prefix
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3961 may contain the following @samp{%} escapes:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3962
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3963 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3964 %f Current file name, directory and extension stripped.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3965 %F Current file name relative to master file directory.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3966 %m Master file name, directory and extension stripped.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3967 %M Directory name (without path) where master file is located.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3968 %u User login name, on systems which support this.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3969 %S A section prefix derived with variable @code{reftex-section-prefixes}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3970 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3971
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3972 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3973 Example: In a file @file{intro.tex}, @samp{eq:%f:} will become
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3974 @samp{eq:intro:}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3975
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3976 @item @var{reference-format}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3977 Format string for reference insert in buffer. @samp{%s} will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3978 replaced by the label. When the format starts with @samp{~}, this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3979 @samp{~} will only be inserted when the character before point is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3980 @emph{not} a whitespace.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3981
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3982 @item @var{context-method}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3983 Indication on how to find the short context.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3984 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3985 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3986 If @code{nil}, use the text following the @samp{\label@{...@}} macro.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3987 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3988 If @code{t}, use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3989 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3990 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3991 the section heading for section labels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3992 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3993 text following the @samp{\begin@{...@}} statement of environments (not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3994 a good choice for environments like eqnarray or enumerate, where one has
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3995 several labels in a single environment).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3996 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3997 text after the macro name (starting with the first arg) for
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
3998 macros.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3999 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4000 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4001 If an integer, use the nth argument of the macro. As a special case,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4002 1000 means to get text after the last macro argument.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4003 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4004 If a string, use as regexp to search @emph{backward} from the label.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4005 Context is then the text following the end of the match. E.g. putting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4006 this to @samp{\\caption[[@{]} will use the caption in a figure or table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4007 environment. @samp{\\begin@{eqnarray@}\|\\\\} works for
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4008 eqnarrays.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4009 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4010 If any of @code{caption}, @code{item}, @code{eqnarray-like},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4011 @code{alignat-like}, this symbol will internally be translated into an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4012 appropriate regexp (see also the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4013 @code{reftex-default-context-regexps}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4014 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4015 If a function, call this function with the name of the environment/macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4016 as argument. On call, point will be just after the @code{\label} macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4017 The function is expected to return a suitable context string. It should
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4018 throw an exception (error) when failing to find context. As an example,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4019 here is a function returning the 10 chars following the label macro as
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4020 context:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4021
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4022 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4023 (defun my-context-function (env-or-mac)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4024 (if (> (point-max) (+ 10 (point)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4025 (buffer-substring (point) (+ 10 (point)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4026 (error "Buffer too small")))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4027 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4028 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4029
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4030 Label context is used in two ways by @b{Ref@TeX{}}: For display in the label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4031 menu, and to derive a label string. If you want to use a different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4032 method for each of these, specify them as a dotted pair.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4033 E.g. @code{(nil . t)} uses the text after the label (@code{nil}) for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4034 display, and text from the default position (@code{t}) to derive a label
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4035 string. This is actually used for section labels.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4036
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4037 @item @var{magic-word-list}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4038 List of magic words which identify a reference to be of this type. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4039 the word before point is equal to one of these words when calling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4040 @code{reftex-reference}, the label list offered will be automatically
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4041 restricted to labels of the correct type. If the first element of this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4042 word--list is the symbol `regexp', the strings are interpreted as regular
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4043 expressions.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4044
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4045 @item @var{toc-level}
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4046 The integer level at which this environment should be added to the table
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4047 of contents. See also @code{reftex-section-levels}. A positive value
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4048 will number the entries mixed with the sectioning commands of the same
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4049 level. A negative value will make unnumbered entries. Useful only for
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4050 theorem-like environments which structure the document. Will be ignored
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4051 for macros. When omitted or @code{nil}, no TOC entries will be
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4052 made.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4053 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4054
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4055 If the type indicator characters of two or more entries are the same,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4056 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will use
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4057 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4058 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4059 the first non-@code{nil} format and prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4060 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4061 the magic words of all involved entries.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4062 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4063
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4064 Any list entry may also be a symbol. If that has an association in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4065 @code{reftex-label-alist-builtin}, the @code{cddr} of that association is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4066 spliced into the list. However, builtin defaults should normally be set
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4067 with the variable @code{reftex-default-label-alist-entries}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4068 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4069
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4070 @defopt reftex-section-prefixes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4071 Prefixes for section labels. When the label prefix given in an entry in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4072 @code{reftex-label-alist} contains @samp{%S}, this list is used to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4073 determine the correct prefix string depending on the current section
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4074 level. The list is an alist, with each entry of the form
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4075 @w{@code{(@var{key} . @var{prefix})}}. Possible keys are sectioning macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4076 names like @samp{chapter}, integer section levels (as given in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4077 @code{reftex-section-levels}), and @code{t} for the default.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4078 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4079
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4080 @defopt reftex-default-context-regexps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4081 Alist with default regular expressions for finding context. The emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4082 lisp form @w{@code{(format regexp (regexp-quote environment))}} is used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4083 to calculate the final regular expression - so @samp{%s} will be
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4084 replaced with the environment or macro.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4085 @end defopt
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4086
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4087 @defopt reftex-trust-label-prefix
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4088 Non-@code{nil} means, trust the label prefix when determining label type.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4089 It is customary to use special label prefixes to distinguish different label
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4090 types. The label prefixes have no syntactic meaning in LaTeX (unless
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4091 special packages like fancyref) are being used. RefTeX can and by
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4092 default does parse around each label to detect the correct label type,
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4093 but this process can be slow when a document contains thousands of
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4094 labels. If you use label prefixes consistently, you may speed up
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4095 document parsing by setting this variable to a non-nil value. RefTeX
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4096 will then compare the label prefix with the prefixes found in
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4097 `reftex-label-alist' and derive the correct label type in this way.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4098 Possible values for this option are:
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4099
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4100 @example
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4101 t @r{This means to trust any label prefixes found.}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4102 regexp @r{If a regexp, only prefixes matched by the regexp are trusted.}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4103 list @r{List of accepted prefixes, as strings. The colon is part of}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4104 @r{the prefix, e.g. ("fn:" "eqn:" "item:").}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4105 nil @r{Never trust a label prefix.}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4106 @end example
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4107 The only disadvantage of using this feature is that the label context
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4108 displayed in the label selection buffer along with each label is
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4109 simply some text after the label definition. This is no problem if you
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4110 place labels keeping this in mind (e.g. @i{before} the equation, @i{at
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4111 the beginning} of a fig/tab caption ...). Anyway, it is probably best
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4112 to use the regexp or the list value types to fine-tune this feature.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4113 For example, if your document contains thousands of footnotes with
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4114 labels fn:xxx, you may want to set this variable to the value "^fn:$" or
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4115 ("fn:"). Then RefTeX will still do extensive parsing for any
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4116 non-footnote labels.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4117 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4118
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4119 @node Options (Creating Labels), Options (Referencing Labels), Options (Defining Label Environments), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4120 @section Creating Labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4121 @cindex Options, creating labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4122 @cindex Creating labels, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4123
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4124 @defopt reftex-insert-label-flags
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4125 Flags governing label insertion. The value has the form
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4126
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4127 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4128 (@var{derive} @var{prompt})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4129 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4130
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4131 If @var{derive}is @code{t}, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will try to derive a sensible
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4132 label from context. A section label for example will be derived from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4133 the section heading. The conversion of the context to a legal label is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4134 governed by the specifications given in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4135 @code{reftex-derive-label-parameters}. If @var{derive} is @code{nil},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4136 the default label will consist of the prefix and a unique number, like
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4137 @samp{eq:23}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4138
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4139 If @var{prompt} is @code{t}, the user will be prompted for a label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4140 string. When @var{prompt} is @code{nil}, the default label will be
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4141 inserted without query.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4142
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4143 So the combination of @var{derive} and @var{prompt} controls label
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4144 insertion. Here is a table describing all four possibilities:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4145
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4146 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4147 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4148 @var{derive} @var{prompt} @var{action}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4149 -----------------------------------------------------------
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4150 nil nil @r{Insert simple label, like @samp{eq:22} or @samp{sec:13}. No query.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4151 nil t @r{Prompt for label.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4152 t nil @r{Derive a label from context and insert. No query.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4153 t t @r{Derive a label from context, prompt for confirmation.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4154 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4155 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4156
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4157 Each flag may be set to @code{t}, @code{nil}, or a string of label type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4158 letters indicating the label types for which it should be true. Thus,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4159 the combination may be set differently for each label type. The default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4160 settings @samp{"s"} and @samp{"sft"} mean: Derive section labels from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4161 headings (with confirmation). Prompt for figure and table labels. Use
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4162 simple labels without confirmation for everything else.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4163
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4164 The available label types are: @code{s} (section), @code{f} (figure),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4165 @code{t} (table), @code{i} (item), @code{e} (equation), @code{n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4166 (footnote), @code{N} (endnote) plus any definitions in
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4167 @code{reftex-label-alist}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4168 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4169
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4170 @deffn Hook reftex-format-label-function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4171 If non-@code{nil}, should be a function which produces the string to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4172 insert as a label definition. The function will be called with two
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4173 arguments, the @var{label} and the @var{default-format} (usually
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4174 @samp{\label@{%s@}}). It should return the string to insert into the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4175 buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4176 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4177
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4178 @deffn Hook reftex-string-to-label-function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4179 Function to turn an arbitrary string into a legal label.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4180 @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s default function uses the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4181 @code{reftex-derive-label-parameters}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4182 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4183
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4184 @deffn Hook reftex-translate-to-ascii-function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4185 Filter function which will process a context string before it is used to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4186 derive a label from it. The intended application is to convert ISO or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4187 Mule characters into something legal in labels. The default function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4188 @code{reftex-latin1-to-ascii} removes the accents from Latin-1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4189 characters. X-Symbol (>=2.6) sets this variable to the much more
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4190 general @code{x-symbol-translate-to-ascii}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4191 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4192
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4193 @defopt reftex-derive-label-parameters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4194 Parameters for converting a string into a label. This variable is a
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4195 list of the following items:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4196 @table @asis
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4197 @item @var{nwords}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4198 Number of words to use.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4199 @item @var{maxchar}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4200 Maximum number of characters in a label string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4201 @item @var{illegal}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4202 @code{nil}: Throw away any words containing characters illegal in labels.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4203 @code{t}: Throw away only the illegal characters, not the whole word.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4204 @item @var{abbrev}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4205 @code{nil}: Never abbreviate words.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4206 @code{t}: Always abbreviate words (see @code{reftex-abbrev-parameters}).@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4207 @code{1}: Abbreviate words if necessary to shorten label string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4208 @item @var{separator}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4209 String separating different words in the label.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4210 @item @var{ignorewords}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4211 List of words which should not be part of labels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4212 @item @var{downcase}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4213 @code{t}: Downcase words before putting them into the label.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4214 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4215 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4216
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4217 @defopt reftex-label-illegal-re
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4218 Regexp matching characters not legal in labels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4219 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4220
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4221 @defopt reftex-abbrev-parameters
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4222 Parameters for abbreviation of words. A list of four parameters.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4223 @table @asis
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4224 @item @var{min-chars}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4225 Minimum number of characters remaining after abbreviation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4226 @item @var{min-kill}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4227 Minimum number of characters to remove when abbreviating words.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4228 @item @var{before}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4229 Character class before abbrev point in word.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4230 @item @var{after}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4231 Character class after abbrev point in word.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4232 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4233 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4234
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4235 @node Options (Referencing Labels), Options (Creating Citations), Options (Creating Labels), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4236 @section Referencing Labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4237 @cindex Options, referencing labels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4238 @cindex Referencing labels, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4239
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4240 @defopt reftex-label-menu-flags
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4241 List of flags governing the label menu makeup. The flags are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4242 @table @asis
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4243 @item @var{table-of-contents}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4244 Show the labels embedded in a table of context.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4245 @item @var{section-numbers}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4246 Include section numbers (like 4.1.3) in table of contents.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4247 @item @var{counters}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4248 Show counters. This just numbers the labels in the menu.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4249 @item @var{no-context}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4250 Non-@code{nil} means do @emph{not} show the short context.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4251 @item @var{follow}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4252 Follow full context in other window.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4253 @item @var{show-commented}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4254 Show labels from regions which are commented out.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4255 @item @var{match-everywhere}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4256 Obsolete flag.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4257 @item @var{show-files}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4258 Show begin and end of included files.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4259 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4260
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4261 Each of these flags can be set to @code{t} or @code{nil}, or to a string
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4262 of type letters indicating the label types for which it should be true.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4263 These strings work like character classes in regular expressions. Thus,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4264 setting one of the flags to @samp{"sf"} makes the flag true for section
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4265 and figure labels, @code{nil} for everything else. Setting it to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4266 @samp{"^sf"} makes it the other way round.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4267
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4268 The available label types are: @code{s} (section), @code{f} (figure),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4269 @code{t} (table), @code{i} (item), @code{e} (equation), @code{n}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4270 (footnote), plus any definitions in @code{reftex-label-alist}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4271
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4272 Most options can also be switched from the label menu itself - so if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4273 decide here to not have a table of contents in the label menu, you can
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4274 still get one interactively during selection from the label menu.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4275 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4276
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4277 @defopt reftex-multiref-punctuation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4278 Punctuation strings for multiple references. When marking is used in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4279 the selection buffer to select several references, this variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4280 associates the 3 marking characters @samp{,-+} with prefix strings to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4281 inserted into the buffer before the corresponding @code{\ref} macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4282 This is used to string together whole reference sets, like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4283 @samp{eqs. 1,2,3-5,6 and 7} in a single call to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4284 @code{reftex-reference}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4285 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4286
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4287 @defopt reftex-vref-is-default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4288 Non-@code{nil} means, the varioref macro @code{\vref} is used as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4289 default. In the selection buffer, the @kbd{v} key toggles the reference
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4290 macro between @code{\ref} and @code{\vref}. The value of this variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4291 determines the default which is active when entering the selection
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4292 process. Instead of @code{nil} or @code{t}, this may also be a string
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4293 of type letters indicating the label types for which it should be
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4294 true.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4295 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4296
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4297 @defopt reftex-fref-is-default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4298 Non-@code{nil} means, the fancyref macro @code{\fref} is used as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4299 default. In the selection buffer, the @kbd{V} key toggles the reference
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4300 macro between @code{\ref}, @code{\fref} and @code{\Fref}. The value of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4301 this variable determines the default which is active when entering the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4302 selection process. Instead of @code{nil} or @code{t}, this may also be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4303 a string of type letters indicating the label types for which it should
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4304 be true.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4305 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4306
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4307 @deffn Hook reftex-format-ref-function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4308 If non-@code{nil}, should be a function which produces the string to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4309 insert as a reference. Note that the insertion format can also be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4310 changed with @code{reftex-label-alist}. This hook also is used by the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4311 special commands to insert @code{\vref} and @code{\fref} references, so
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4312 even if you set this, your setting will be ignored by the special
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4313 commands. The function will be called with two arguments, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4314 @var{label} and the @var{default-format} (usually @samp{~\ref@{%s@}}).
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4315 It should return the string to insert into the buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4316 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4317
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4318 @defopt reftex-level-indent
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4319 Number of spaces to be used for indentation per section level.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4320 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4321
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4322 @defopt reftex-guess-label-type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4323 Non-@code{nil} means, @code{reftex-reference} will try to guess the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4324 label type. To do that, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will look at the word before the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4325 cursor and compare it with the magic words given in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4326 @code{reftex-label-alist}. When it finds a match, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4327 immediately offer the correct label menu - otherwise it will prompt you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4328 for a label type. If you set this variable to @code{nil}, @b{Ref@TeX{}}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4329 will always prompt for a label type.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4330 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4331
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4332 @deffn {Normal Hook} reftex-display-copied-context-hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4333 Normal Hook which is run before context is displayed anywhere. Designed
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4334 for @w{@code{X-Symbol}}, but may have other uses as well.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4335 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4336
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4337 @deffn Hook reftex-pre-refontification-functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4338 @code{X-Symbol} specific hook. Probably not useful for other purposes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4339 The functions get two arguments, the buffer from where the command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4340 started and a symbol indicating in what context the hook is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4341 called.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4342 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4343
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4344 @deffn {Normal Hook} reftex-select-label-mode-hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4345 Normal hook which is run when a selection buffer enters
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4346 @code{reftex-select-label-mode}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4347 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4348
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4349 @deffn Keymap reftex-select-label-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4350 The keymap which is active in the labels selection process
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4351 (@pxref{Referencing Labels}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4352 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4353
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4354 @node Options (Creating Citations), Options (Index Support), Options (Referencing Labels), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4355 @section Creating Citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4356 @cindex Options, creating citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4357 @cindex Creating citations, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4358
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4359 @defopt reftex-bibliography-commands
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4360 LaTeX commands which specify the BibTeX databases to use with the document.
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4361 @end defopt
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4362
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4363 @defopt reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4364 List of regular expressions to exclude files in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4365 @code{\\bibliography@{..@}}. File names matched by any of these regexps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4366 will not be parsed. Intended for files which contain only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4367 @code{@@string} macro definitions and the like, which are ignored by
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4368 @b{Ref@TeX{}} anyway.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4369 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4370
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4371 @defopt reftex-default-bibliography
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4372 List of BibTeX database files which should be used if none are specified.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4373 When @code{reftex-citation} is called from a document with neither
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4374 a @samp{\bibliography@{...@}} statement nor a @code{thebibliography}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4375 environment, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will scan these files instead. Intended for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4376 using @code{reftex-citation} in non-LaTeX files. The files will be
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4377 searched along the BIBINPUTS or TEXBIB path.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4378 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4379
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4380 @defopt reftex-sort-bibtex-matches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4381 Sorting of the entries found in BibTeX databases by reftex-citation.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4382 Possible values:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4383 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4384 nil @r{Do not sort entries.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4385 author @r{Sort entries by author name.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4386 year @r{Sort entries by increasing year.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4387 reverse-year @r{Sort entries by decreasing year.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4388 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4389 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4390
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4391 @defopt reftex-cite-format
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4392 The format of citations to be inserted into the buffer. It can be a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4393 string, an alist or a symbol. In the simplest case this is just the string
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4394 @samp{\cite@{%l@}}, which is also the default. See the definition of
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4395 @code{reftex-cite-format-builtin} for more complex examples.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4396
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4397 If @code{reftex-cite-format} is a string, it will be used as the format.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4398 In the format, the following percent escapes will be expanded.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4399
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4400 @table @code
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4401 @item %l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4402 The BibTeX label of the citation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4403 @item %a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4404 List of author names, see also @code{reftex-cite-punctuation}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4405 @item %2a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4406 Like %a, but abbreviate more than 2 authors like Jones et al.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4407 @item %A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4408 First author name only.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4409 @item %e
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4410 Works like @samp{%a}, but on list of editor names. (@samp{%2e} and
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4411 @samp{%E} work a well).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4412 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4413
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4414 It is also possible to access all other BibTeX database fields:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4415
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4416 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4417 %b booktitle %c chapter %d edition %h howpublished
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4418 %i institution %j journal %k key %m month
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4419 %n number %o organization %p pages %P first page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4420 %r address %s school %u publisher %t title
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4421 %v volume %y year
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4422 %B booktitle, abbreviated %T title, abbreviated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4423 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4424
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4425 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4426 Usually, only @samp{%l} is needed. The other stuff is mainly for the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4427 echo area display, and for @code{(setq reftex-comment-citations t)}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4428
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4429 @samp{%<} as a special operator kills punctuation and space around it
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4430 after the string has been formatted.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4431
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4432 A pair of square brackets indicates an optional argument, and RefTeX
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4433 will prompt for the values of these arguments.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4434
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4435 Beware that all this only works with BibTeX database files. When
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4436 citations are made from the @code{\bibitems} in an explicit
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4437 @code{thebibliography} environment, only @samp{%l} is available.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4438
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4439 If @code{reftex-cite-format} is an alist of characters and strings, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4440 user will be prompted for a character to select one of the possible
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4441 format strings.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4442
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4443 In order to configure this variable, you can either set
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4444 @code{reftex-cite-format} directly yourself or set it to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4445 @emph{symbol} of one of the predefined styles. The predefined symbols
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4446 are those which have an association in the constant
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4447 @code{reftex-cite-format-builtin}) E.g.: @code{(setq reftex-cite-format
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4448 'natbib)}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4449 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4450
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4451 @deffn Hook reftex-format-cite-function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4452 If non-@code{nil}, should be a function which produces the string to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4453 insert as a citation. Note that the citation format can also be changed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4454 with the variable @code{reftex-cite-format}. The function will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4455 called with two arguments, the @var{citation-key} and the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4456 @var{default-format} (taken from @code{reftex-cite-format}). It should
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4457 return the string to insert into the buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4458 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4459
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4460 @defopt reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4461 Non-@code{nil} means, prompt for empty optional arguments in cite macros.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4462 When an entry in @code{reftex-cite-format} ist given with square brackets to
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4463 indicate optional arguments (for example @samp{\\cite[][]@{%l@}}), RefTeX can
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4464 prompt for values. Possible values are:
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4465 @example
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4466 nil @r{Never prompt for optional arguments}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4467 t @r{Always prompt}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4468 maybe @r{Prompt only if @code{reftex-citation} was called with C-u prefix arg}@end example
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4469 Unnecessary empty optional arguments are removed before insertion into
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4470 the buffer. See @code{reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4471 @end defopt
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4472
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4473 @defopt reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4474 Non-@code{nil} means, remove empty optional arguments from cite macros
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4475 if possible.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4476 @end defopt
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4477
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4478 @defopt reftex-comment-citations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4479 Non-@code{nil} means add a comment for each citation describing the full
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4480 entry. The comment is formatted according to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4481 @code{reftex-cite-comment-format}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4482 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4483
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4484 @defopt reftex-cite-comment-format
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4485 Citation format used for commented citations. Must @emph{not} contain
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4486 @samp{%l}. See the variable @code{reftex-cite-format} for possible
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4487 percent escapes.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4488 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4489
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4490 @defopt reftex-cite-punctuation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4491 Punctuation for formatting of name lists in citations. This is a list
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4492 of 3 strings.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4493 @enumerate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4494 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4495 normal names separator, like @samp{, } in Jones, Brown and Miller
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4496 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4497 final names separator, like @samp{ and } in Jones, Brown and Miller
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4498 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4499 The @samp{et al.} string, like @samp{ @{\it et al.@}} in
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4500 Jones @{\it et al.@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4501 @end enumerate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4502 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4503
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4504 @deffn {Normal Hook} reftex-select-bib-mode-hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4505 Normal hook which is run when a selection buffer enters
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4506 @code{reftex-select-bib-mode}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4507 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4508
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4509 @deffn Keymap reftex-select-bib-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4510 The keymap which is active in the citation-key selection process
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4511 (@pxref{Creating Citations}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4512 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4513
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4514 @node Options (Index Support), Options (Viewing Cross-References), Options (Creating Citations), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4515 @section Index Support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4516 @cindex Options, Index support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4517 @cindex Index support, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4518
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4519 @defopt reftex-support-index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4520 Non-@code{nil} means, index entries are parsed as well. Index support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4521 is resource intensive and the internal structure holding the parsed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4522 information can become quite big. Therefore it can be turned off. When
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4523 this is @code{nil} and you execute a command which requires index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4524 support, you will be asked for confirmation to turn it on and rescan the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4525 document.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4526 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4527
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4528 @defopt reftex-index-special-chars
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4529 List of special characters in index entries, given as strings. These
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4530 correspond to the @code{MakeIndex} keywords
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4531 @code{(@var{level} @var{encap} @var{actual} @var{quote} @var{escape})}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4532 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4533
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4534 @defopt reftex-index-macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4535 List of macros which define index entries. The structure of each entry
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4536 is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4537 @lisp
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4538 (@var{macro} @var{index-tag} @var{key} @var{prefix} @var{exclude} @var{repeat})
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4539 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4540
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4541 @var{macro} is the macro. Arguments should be denoted by empty braces,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4542 as for example in @samp{\index[]@{*@}}. Use square brackets to denote
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4543 optional arguments. The star marks where the index key is.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4544
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4545 @var{index-tag} is a short name of the index. @samp{idx} and @samp{glo}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4546 are reserved for the default index and the glossary. Other indices can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4547 be defined as well. If this is an integer, the Nth argument of the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4548 macro holds the index tag.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4549
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4550 @var{key} is a character which is used to identify the macro for input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4551 with @code{reftex-index}. @samp{?i}, @samp{?I}, and @samp{?g} are
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4552 reserved for default index and glossary.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4553
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4554 @var{prefix} can be a prefix which is added to the @var{key} part of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4555 index entry. If you have a macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4556 @code{\newcommand@{\molec@}[1]@{#1\index@{Molecules!#1@}}, this prefix
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4557 should be @samp{Molecules!}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4558
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4559 @var{exclude} can be a function. If this function exists and returns a
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4560 non-nil value, the index entry at point is ignored. This was
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4561 implemented to support the (deprecated) @samp{^} and @samp{_} shortcuts
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4562 in the LaTeX2e @code{index} package.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4563
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4564 @var{repeat}, if non-@code{nil}, means the index macro does not typeset
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4565 the entry in the text, so that the text has to be repeated outside the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4566 index macro. Needed for @code{reftex-index-selection-or-word} and for
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4567 indexing from the phrase buffer.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4568
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4569 The final entry may also be a symbol. It must have an association in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4570 the variable @code{reftex-index-macros-builtin} to specify the main
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4571 indexing package you are using. Legal values are currently
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4572 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4573 default @r{The LaTeX default - unnecessary to specify this one}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4574 multind @r{The multind.sty package}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4575 index @r{The index.sty package}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4576 index-shortcut @r{The index.sty packages with the ^ and _ shortcuts.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4577 @r{Should not be used - only for old documents}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4578 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4579 Note that AUCTeX sets these things internally for @b{Ref@TeX{}} as well,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4580 so with a sufficiently new version of AUCTeX, you should not set the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4581 package here.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4582 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4583
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4584 @defopt reftex-index-default-macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4585 The default index macro for @code{reftex-index-selection-or-word}.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4586 This is a list with @code{(@var{macro-key} @var{default-tag})}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4587
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4588 @var{macro-key} is a character identifying an index macro - see
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4589 @code{reftex-index-macros}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4590
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4591 @var{default-tag} is the tag to be used if the macro requires a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4592 @var{tag} argument. When this is @code{nil} and a @var{tag} is needed,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4593 @b{Ref@TeX{}} will ask for it. When this is the empty string and the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4594 TAG argument of the index macro is optional, the TAG argument will be
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4595 omitted.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4596 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4597
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4598 @defopt reftex-index-default-tag
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4599 Default index tag. When working with multiple indexes, RefTeX queries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4600 for an index tag when creating index entries or displaying a specific
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4601 index. This variable controls the default offered for these queries.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4602 The default can be selected with @key{RET} during selection or
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4603 completion. Legal values of this variable are:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4604 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4605 nil @r{Do not provide a default index}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4606 "tag" @r{The default index tag given as a string, e.g. "idx"}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4607 last @r{The last used index tag will be offered as default}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4608 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4609 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4610
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4611 @defopt reftex-index-math-format
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4612 Format of index entries when copied from inside math mode. When
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4613 @code{reftex-index-selection-or-word} is executed inside TeX math mode,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4614 the index key copied from the buffer is processed with this format
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4615 string through the @code{format} function. This can be used to add the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4616 math delimiters (e.g. @samp{$}) to the string. Requires the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4617 @file{texmathp.el} library which is part of AUCTeX.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4618 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4619
27195
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4620 @defopt reftex-index-phrase-file-extension
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4621 File extension for the index phrase file. This extension will be added
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4622 to the base name of the master file.
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4623 @end defopt
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4624
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4625 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-logical-and-regexp
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4626 Regexp matching the @samp{and} operator for index arguments in phrases
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4627 file. When several index arguments in a phrase line are separated by
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4628 this operator, each part will generate an index macro. So each match of
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4629 the search phrase will produce @emph{several} different index entries.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4630 Make sure this does no match things which are not separators. This
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4631 logical @samp{and} has higher priority than the logical @samp{or}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4632 specified in @code{reftex-index-phrases-logical-or-regexp}.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4633 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4634
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4635 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-logical-or-regexp
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4636 Regexp matching the @samp{or} operator for index arguments in phrases
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4637 file. When several index arguments in a phrase line are separated by
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4638 this operator, the user will be asked to select one of them at each
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4639 match of the search phrase. The first index arg will be the default. A
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4640 number key @kbd{1}--@kbd{9} must be pressed to switch to another. Make
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4641 sure this does no match things which are not separators. The logical
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4642 @samp{and} specified in @code{reftex-index-phrases-logical-or-regexp}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4643 has higher priority than this logical @samp{or}.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4644 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4645
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4646 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-search-whole-words
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4647 Non-@code{nil} means phrases search will look for whole words, not subwords.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4648 This works by requiring word boundaries at the beginning and end of
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4649 the search string. When the search phrase already has a non-word-char
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4650 at one of these points, no word boundary is required there.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4651 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4652
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4653 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-case-fold-search
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4654 Non-@code{nil} means, searching for index phrases will ignore
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4655 case.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4656 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4657
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4658 @defopt reftex-index-verify-function
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4659 A function which is called at each match during global indexing.
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4660 If the function returns nil, the current match is skipped.
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4661 @end defopt
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4662
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4663 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-skip-indexed-matches
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4664 Non-@code{nil} means, skip matches which appear to be indexed already.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4665 When doing global indexing from the phrases buffer, searches for some
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4666 phrases may match at places where that phrase was already indexed. In
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4667 particular when indexing an already processed document again, this
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4668 will even be the norm. When this variable is non-@code{nil},
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4669 @b{Ref@TeX{}} checks if the match is an index macro argument, or if an
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4670 index macro is directly before or after the phrase. If that is the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4671 case, that match will be ignored.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4672 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4673
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4674 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-wrap-long-lines
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4675 Non-@code{nil} means, when indexing from the phrases buffer, wrap lines.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4676 Inserting indexing commands in a line makes the line longer - often
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4677 so long that it does not fit onto the screen. When this variable is
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4678 non-@code{nil}, newlines will be added as necessary before and/or after the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4679 indexing command to keep lines short. However, the matched text
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4680 phrase and its index command will always end up on a single line.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4681 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4682
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4683 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-sort-prefers-entry
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4684 Non-@code{nil} means when sorting phrase lines, the explicit index entry
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4685 is used. Phrase lines in the phrases buffer contain a search phrase, and
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4686 sorting is normally based on these. Some phrase lines also have
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4687 an explicit index argument specified. When this variable is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4688 non-@code{nil}, the index argument will be used for sorting.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4689 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4690
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4691 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-sort-in-blocks
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4692 Non-@code{nil} means, empty and comment lines separate phrase buffer
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4693 into blocks. Sorting will then preserve blocks, so that lines are
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4694 re-arranged only within blocks.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4695 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4696
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4697 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-map
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4698 Keymap for the Index Phrases buffer.
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4699 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4700
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4701 @defopt reftex-index-phrases-mode-hook
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4702 Normal hook which is run when a buffer is put into
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4703 @code{reftex-index-phrases-mode}.
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4704 @end defopt
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4705
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4706 @defopt reftex-index-section-letters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4707 The letters which denote sections in the index. Usually these are all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4708 capital letters. Don't use any downcase letters. Order is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4709 significant, the index will be sorted by whatever the sort function
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4710 thinks is correct. In addition to these letters, @b{Ref@TeX{}} will
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4711 create a group @samp{!} which contains all entries sorted below the
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4712 lowest specified letter. In the @file{*Index*} buffer, pressing any of
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4713 these capital letters or @kbd{!} will jump to that section.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4714 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4715
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4716 @defopt reftex-index-include-context
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4717 Non-@code{nil} means, display the index definition context in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4718 @file{*Index*} buffer. This flag may also be toggled from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4719 @file{*Index*} buffer with the @kbd{c} key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4720 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4721
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4722 @defopt reftex-index-follow-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4723 Non-@code{nil} means, point in @file{*Index*} buffer will cause other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4724 window to follow. The other window will show the corresponding part of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4725 the document. This flag can be toggled from within the @file{*Index*}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4726 buffer with the @kbd{f} key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4727 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4728
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4729 @deffn Keymap reftex-index-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4730 The keymap which is active in the @file{*Index*} buffer
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4731 (@pxref{Index Support}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4732 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4733
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4734 @node Options (Viewing Cross-References), Options (Finding Files), Options (Index Support), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4735 @section Viewing Cross-References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4736 @cindex Options, viewing cross-references
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4737 @cindex Viewing cross-references, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4738
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4739 @defopt reftex-view-crossref-extra
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4740 Macros which can be used for the display of cross references.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4741 This is used when `reftex-view-crossref' is called with point in an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4742 argument of a macro. Note that crossref viewing for citations,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4743 references (both ways) and index entries is hard-coded. This variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4744 is only to configure additional structures for which crossreference
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4745 viewing can be useful. Each entry has the structure
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4746 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4747 (@var{macro-re} @var{search-re} @var{highlight}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4748 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4749 @var{macro-re} is matched against the macro. @var{search-re} is the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4750 regexp used to search for cross references. @samp{%s} in this regexp is
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
4751 replaced with the macro argument at point. @var{highlight} is an
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4752 integer indicating which subgroup of the match should be highlighted.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4753 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4754
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4755 @defopt reftex-auto-view-crossref
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4756 Non-@code{nil} means, initially turn automatic viewing of crossref info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4757 on. Automatic viewing of crossref info normally uses the echo area.
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
4758 Whenever point is idle for more than @code{reftex-idle-time} seconds on
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
4759 the argument of a @code{\ref} or @code{\cite} macro, and no other
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
4760 message is being displayed, the echo area will display information about
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
4761 that cross reference. You can also set the variable to the symbol
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
4762 @code{window}. In this case a small temporary window is used for the
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
4763 display. This feature can be turned on and off from the menu
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4764 (Ref->Options).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4765 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4766
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4767 @defopt reftex-idle-time
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4768 Time (secs) Emacs has to be idle before automatic crossref display
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4769 or toc recentering is done.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4770 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4771
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4772 @defopt reftex-cite-view-format
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4773 Citation format used to display citation info in the message area. See
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4774 the variable @code{reftex-cite-format} for possible percent
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4775 escapes.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4776 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4777
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4778 @defopt reftex-revisit-to-echo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4779 Non-@code{nil} means, automatic citation display will revisit files if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4780 necessary. When nil, citation display in echo area will only be active
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4781 for cached echo strings (see @code{reftex-cache-cite-echo}), or for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4782 BibTeX database files which are already visited by a live associated
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4783 buffers.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4784 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4785
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4786 @defopt reftex-cache-cite-echo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4787 Non-@code{nil} means, the information displayed in the echo area for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4788 cite macros (see variable @code{reftex-auto-view-crossref}) is cached and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4789 saved along with the parsing information. The cache survives document
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4790 scans. In order to clear it, use @kbd{M-x reftex-reset-mode}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4791 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4792
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4793 @node Options (Finding Files), Options (Optimizations), Options (Viewing Cross-References), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4794 @section Finding Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4795 @cindex Options, Finding Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4796 @cindex Finding files, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4797
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4798 @defopt reftex-texpath-environment-variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4799 List of specifications how to retrieve the search path for TeX files.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4800 Several entries are possible.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4801 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4802 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4803 If an element is the name of an environment variable, its content is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4804 used.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4805 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4806 If an element starts with an exclamation mark, it is used as a command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4807 to retrieve the path. A typical command with the kpathsearch library
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4808 would be @w{@code{"!kpsewhich -show-path=.tex"}}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4809 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4810 Otherwise the element itself is interpreted as a path.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4811 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4812 Multiple directories can be separated by the system dependent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4813 @code{path-separator}. Directories ending in @samp{//} or @samp{!!} will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4814 be expanded recursively. See also @code{reftex-use-external-file-finders}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4815 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4816
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4817 @defopt reftex-bibpath-environment-variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4818 List of specifications how to retrieve the search path for BibTeX
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4819 files. Several entries are possible.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4820 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4821 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4822 If an element is the name of an environment variable, its content is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4823 used.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4824 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4825 If an element starts with an exclamation mark, it is used as a command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4826 to retrieve the path. A typical command with the kpathsearch library
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4827 would be @w{@code{"!kpsewhich -show-path=.bib"}}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4828 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4829 Otherwise the element itself is interpreted as a path.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4830 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4831 Multiple directories can be separated by the system dependent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4832 @code{path-separator}. Directories ending in @samp{//} or @samp{!!} will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4833 be expanded recursively. See also @code{reftex-use-external-file-finders}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4834 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4835
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4836 @defopt reftex-file-extensions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4837 Association list with file extensions for different file types.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4838 This is a list of items, each item is like:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4839 @code{(@var{type} . (@var{def-ext} @var{other-ext} ...))}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4840 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4841 @var{type}: @r{File type like @code{"bib"} or @code{"tex"}.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4842 @var{def-ext}: @r{The default extension for that file type, like @code{".tex"} or @code{".bib"}.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4843 @var{other-ext}: @r{Any number of other legal extensions for this file type.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4844 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4845 When a files is searched and it does not have any of the legal extensions,
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4846 we try the default extension first, and then the naked file name.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4847 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4848
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4849 @defopt reftex-search-unrecursed-path-first
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4850 Non-@code{nil} means, search all specified directories before trying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4851 recursion. Thus, in a path @samp{.//:/tex/}, search first @samp{./},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4852 then @samp{/tex/}, and then all subdirectories of @samp{./}. If this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4853 option is @code{nil}, the subdirectories of @samp{./} are searched
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4854 before @samp{/tex/}. This is mainly for speed - most of the time the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4855 recursive path is for the system files and not for the user files. Set
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4856 this to @code{nil} if the default makes @b{Ref@TeX{}} finding files with
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4857 equal names in wrong sequence.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4858 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4859
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4860 @defopt reftex-use-external-file-finders
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4861 Non-@code{nil} means, use external programs to find files. Normally,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4862 @b{Ref@TeX{}} searches the paths given in the environment variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4863 @code{TEXINPUTS} and @code{BIBINPUTS} to find TeX files and BibTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4864 database files. With this option turned on, it calls an external
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4865 program specified in the option @code{reftex-external-file-finders}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4866 instead. As a side effect, the variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4867 @code{reftex-texpath-environment-variables} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4868 @code{reftex-bibpath-environment-variables} will be ignored.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4869 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4870
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4871 @defopt reftex-external-file-finders
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4872 Association list with external programs to call for finding files. Each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4873 entry is a cons cell @w{@code{(@var{type} . @var{program})}}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4874 @var{type} is either @code{"tex"} or @code{"bib"}. @var{program} is a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4875 string containing the external program to use with any arguments.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4876 @code{%f} will be replaced by the name of the file to be found. Note
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4877 that these commands will be executed directly, not via a shell. Only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4878 relevant when @code{reftex-use-external-file-finders} is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4879 non-@code{nil}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4880 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4881
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4882 @page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4883 @node Options (Optimizations), Options (Fontification), Options (Finding Files), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4884 @section Optimizations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4885 @cindex Options, optimizations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4886 @cindex Optimizations, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4887
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4888 @defopt reftex-keep-temporary-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4889 Non-@code{nil} means, keep buffers created for parsing and lookup.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4890 @b{Ref@TeX{}} sometimes needs to visit files related to the current
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4891 document. We distinguish files visited for
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4892 @table @asis
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4893 @item PARSING
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4894 Parts of a multifile document loaded when (re)-parsing the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4895 document.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4896 @item LOOKUP
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4897 BibTeX database files and TeX files loaded to find a reference, to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4898 display label context, etc.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4899 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4900 The created buffers can be kept for later use, or be thrown away
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4901 immediately after use, depending on the value of this variable:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4902
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4903 @table @code
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4904 @item nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4905 Throw away as much as possible.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4906 @item t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4907 Keep everything.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4908 @item 1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4909 Throw away buffers created for parsing, but keep the ones created for
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4910 lookup.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4911 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4912
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4913 If a buffer is to be kept, the file is visited normally (which is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4914 potentially slow but will happen only once). If a buffer is to be thrown
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4915 away, the initialization of the buffer depends upon the variable
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4916 @code{reftex-initialize-temporary-buffers}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4917 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4918
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4919 @defopt reftex-initialize-temporary-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4920 Non-@code{nil} means do initializations even when visiting file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4921 temporarily. When @code{nil}, @b{Ref@TeX{}} may turn off find-file hooks and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4922 other stuff to briefly visit a file. When @code{t}, the full default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4923 initializations are done (@code{find-file-hook} etc.). Instead of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4924 @code{t} or @code{nil}, this variable may also be a list of hook
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4925 functions to do a minimal initialization.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4926 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4927
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4928 @defopt reftex-no-include-regexps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4929 List of regular expressions to exclude certain input files from parsing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4930 If the name of a file included via @code{\include} or @code{\input} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4931 matched by any of the regular expressions in this list, that file is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4932 parsed by @b{Ref@TeX{}}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4933 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4934
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4935 @defopt reftex-enable-partial-scans
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4936 Non-@code{nil} means, re-parse only 1 file when asked to re-parse.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4937 Re-parsing is normally requested with a @kbd{C-u} prefix to many @b{Ref@TeX{}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4938 commands, or with the @kbd{r} key in menus. When this option is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4939 @code{t} in a multifile document, we will only parse the current buffer,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4940 or the file associated with the label or section heading near point in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4941 menu. Requesting re-parsing of an entire multifile document then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4942 requires a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix or the capital @kbd{R} key in
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4943 menus.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4944 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4945
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4946 @defopt reftex-save-parse-info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4947 Non-@code{nil} means, save information gathered with parsing in files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4948 The file @file{MASTER.rel} in the same directory as @file{MASTER.tex} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4949 used to save the information. When this variable is @code{t},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4950 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4951 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4952 accessing the parsing information for the first time in an editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4953 session will read that file (if available) instead of parsing the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4954 document.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4955 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4956 exiting Emacs or killing a buffer in reftex-mode will cause a new
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4957 version of the file to be written.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4958 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4959 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4960
27195
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4961 @defopt reftex-parse-file-extension
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4962 File extension for the file in which parser information is stored.
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4963 This extension is added to the base name of the master file.
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4964 @end defopt
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
4965
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4966 @defopt reftex-allow-automatic-rescan
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4967 Non-@code{nil} means, @b{Ref@TeX{}} may rescan the document when this seems
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4968 necessary. Applies (currently) only in rare cases, when a new label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4969 cannot be placed with certainty into the internal label list.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4970 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4971
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4972 @defopt reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4973 Non-@code{nil} means use a separate selection buffer for each label
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4974 type. These buffers are kept from one selection to the next and need
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4975 not to be created for each use - so the menu generally comes up faster.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4976 The selection buffers will be erased (and therefore updated)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4977 automatically when new labels in its category are added. See the
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4978 variable @code{reftex-auto-update-selection-buffers}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4979 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4980
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4981 @defopt reftex-auto-update-selection-buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4982 Non-@code{nil} means, selection buffers will be updated automatically.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4983 When a new label is defined with @code{reftex-label}, all selection
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4984 buffers associated with that label category are emptied, in order to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4985 force an update upon next use. When @code{nil}, the buffers are left
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4986 alone and have to be updated by hand, with the @kbd{g} key from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4987 label selection process. The value of this variable will only have any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4988 effect when @code{reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers} is
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
4989 non-@code{nil}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4990 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4991
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4992 @node Options (Fontification), Options (Misc), Options (Optimizations), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4993 @section Fontification
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4994 @cindex Options, fontification
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4995 @cindex Fontification, options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4996
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4997 @defopt reftex-use-fonts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4998 Non-@code{nil} means, use fonts in label menu and on-the-fly help.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4999 Font-lock must be loaded as well to actually get fontified
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5000 display. After changing this option, a rescan may be necessary to
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5001 activate it.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5002 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5003
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5004 @defopt reftex-refontify-context
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5005 Non-@code{nil} means, re-fontify the context in the label menu with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5006 font-lock. This slightly slows down the creation of the label menu. It
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5007 is only necessary when you definitely want the context fontified.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5008
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5009 This option may have 3 different values:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5010 @table @code
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5011 @item nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5012 Never refontify.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5013 @item t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5014 Always refontify.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5015 @item 1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5016 Refontify when necessary, e.g. with old versions of the x-symbol
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5017 package.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5018 @end table
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5019 The option is ignored when @code{reftex-use-fonts} is @code{nil}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5020 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5021
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5022 @defopt reftex-highlight-selection
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5023 Non-@code{nil} means, highlight selected text in selection and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5024 @file{*toc*} buffers. Normally, the text near the cursor is the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5025 @emph{selected} text, and it is highlighted. This is the entry most
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5026 keys in the selection and @file{*toc*} buffers act on. However, if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5027 mainly use the mouse to select an item, you may find it nice to have
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5028 mouse-triggered highlighting @emph{instead} or @emph{as well}. The
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5029 variable may have one of these values:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5030
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5031 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5032 nil @r{No highlighting.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5033 cursor @r{Highlighting is cursor driven.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5034 mouse @r{Highlighting is mouse driven.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5035 both @r{Both cursor and mouse trigger highlighting.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5036 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5037
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5038 Changing this variable requires to rebuild the selection and *toc*
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5039 buffers to become effective (keys @kbd{g} or @kbd{r}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5040 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5041
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5042 @defopt reftex-cursor-selected-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5043 Face name to highlight cursor selected item in toc and selection buffers.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5044 See also the variable @code{reftex-highlight-selection}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5045 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5046 @defopt reftex-mouse-selected-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5047 Face name to highlight mouse selected item in toc and selection buffers.
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5048 See also the variable @code{reftex-highlight-selection}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5049 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5050 @defopt reftex-file-boundary-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5051 Face name for file boundaries in selection buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5052 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5053 @defopt reftex-label-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5054 Face name for labels in selection buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5055 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5056 @defopt reftex-section-heading-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5057 Face name for section headings in toc and selection buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5058 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5059 @defopt reftex-toc-header-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5060 Face name for the header of a toc buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5061 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5062 @defopt reftex-bib-author-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5063 Face name for author names in bib selection buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5064 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5065 @defopt reftex-bib-year-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5066 Face name for year in bib selection buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5067 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5068 @defopt reftex-bib-title-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5069 Face name for article title in bib selection buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5070 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5071 @defopt reftex-bib-extra-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5072 Face name for bibliographic information in bib selection buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5073 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5074 @defopt reftex-select-mark-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5075 Face name for marked entries in the selection buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5076 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5077 @defopt reftex-index-header-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5078 Face name for the header of an index buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5079 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5080 @defopt reftex-index-section-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5081 Face name for the start of a new letter section in the index.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5082 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5083 @defopt reftex-index-tag-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5084 Face name for index names (for multiple indices).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5085 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5086 @defopt reftex-index-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5087 Face name for index entries.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5088 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5089
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5090 @node Options (Misc), , Options (Fontification), Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5091 @section Miscellaneous
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5092 @cindex Options, misc
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5093
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5094 @defopt reftex-extra-bindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5095 Non-@code{nil} means, make additional key bindings on startup. These
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5096 extra bindings are located in the users @samp{C-c letter}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5097 map. @xref{Key Bindings}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5098 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5099
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5100 @defopt reftex-plug-into-AUCTeX
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5101 Plug-in flags for AUCTeX interface. This variable is a list of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5102 5 boolean flags. When a flag is non-@code{nil}, @b{Ref@TeX{}}
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5103 will
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5104
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5105 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5106 - supply labels in new sections and environments (flag 1)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5107 - supply arguments for macros like @code{\label} (flag 2)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5108 - supply arguments for macros like @code{\ref} (flag 3)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5109 - supply arguments for macros like @code{\cite} (flag 4)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5110 - supply arguments for macros like @code{\index} (flag 5)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5111 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5112
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5113 You may also set the variable itself to t or nil in order to turn all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5114 options on or off, respectively.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5115 Supplying labels in new sections and environments applies when creating
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5116 sections with @kbd{C-c C-s} and environments with @kbd{C-c C-e}.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5117 Supplying macro arguments applies when you insert such a macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5118 interactively with @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5119 See the AUCTeX documentation for more information.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5120 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5121
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5122 @defopt reftex-revisit-to-follow
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5123 Non-@code{nil} means, follow-mode will revisit files if necessary.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5124 When nil, follow-mode will be suspended for stuff in unvisited files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5125 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5126
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5127 @defopt reftex-allow-detached-macro-args
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5128 Non-@code{nil} means, allow arguments of macros to be detached by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5129 whitespace. When this is @code{t}, the @samp{aaa} in @w{@samp{\bbb
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5130 [xxx] @{aaa@}}} will be considered an argument of @code{\bb}. Note that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5131 this will be the case even if @code{\bb} is defined with zero or one
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5132 argument.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5133 @end defopt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5134
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5135 @node Keymaps and Hooks, Changes, Options, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5136 @section Keymaps and Hooks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5137 @cindex Keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5138
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5139 @b{Ref@TeX{}} has the usual general keymap and load-- and mode-hook.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5140
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5141 @deffn Keymap reftex-mode-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5142 The keymap for @b{Ref@TeX{}} mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5143 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5144
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5145 @deffn {Normal Hook} reftex-load-hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5146 Normal hook which is being run when loading @file{reftex.el}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5147 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5148
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5149 @deffn {Normal Hook} reftex-mode-hook
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5150 Normal hook which is being run when turning on @b{Ref@TeX{}} mode.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5151 @end deffn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5152
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
5153 Furthermore, the 4 modes used for referencing labels, creating
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
5154 citations, the table of contents buffer and the phrases buffer have
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
5155 their own keymaps and mode hooks. See the respective sections. There
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
5156 are many more hooks which are described in the relevant sections about
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5157 options for a specific part of @b{Ref@TeX{}}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5158
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5159 @node Changes, , Keymaps and Hooks, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5160 @chapter Changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5161 @cindex Changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5162
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5163 Here is a list of recent changes to @b{Ref@TeX{}}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5164
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5165 @noindent @b{Version 4.26}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5166 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5167 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5168 Bug fixes only.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5169 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5170
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5171 @noindent @b{Version 4.25}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5172 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5173 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5174 Fixed bug with @samp{%F} in a label prefix. Added new escapes
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5175 @samp{%m} and @samp{%M} for mater file name and master directory.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5176 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5177
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5178 @noindent @b{Version 4.24}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5179 @itemize @bullet
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5180 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5181 Inserting citation commands now prompts for optional arguments
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5182 when called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5183 @code{reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args} and
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5184 @code{reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5185 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5186 New option @code{reftex-trust-label-prefix}. Configure this variable
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5187 if you'd like RefTeX to base its classification of labels on prefixes.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5188 This can speed-up document parsing, but may in some cases reduce the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5189 quality of the context used by RefTeX to describe a label.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5190 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5191 Fixed bug in @code{reftex-create-bibtex-file} when @code{reftex-comment-citations}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5192 is non-nil.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5193 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5194 Fixed bugs in indexing: Case-sensitive search, quotes before and/or
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5195 after words. Disabbled indexing in comment lines.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5196 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5197
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5198 @noindent @b{Version 4.22}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5199 @itemize @bullet
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5200 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5201 New command @code{reftex-create-bibtex-file} to create a new database
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5202 with all entries referenced in the current document.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5203 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5204 New keys @kbd{e} and @kbd{E} allow to produce a BibTeX database file
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5205 from entries marked in a citation selection buffer.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5206 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5207
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5208 @noindent @b{Version 4.21}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5209 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5210 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5211 Renaming labels from the toc buffer with key @kbd{M-%}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5212 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5213
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5214 @noindent @b{Version 4.20}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5215 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5216 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5217 Structure editing capabilities. The command keys @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} in
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5218 the TOC buffer promote/demote the section at point or all sections in
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5219 the current region.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5220 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5221 New option @code{reftex-toc-split-windows-fraction} to set the size of
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5222 the window used by the TOC. This makes the old variable
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5223 @code{reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally-fraction} obsolete.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5224 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5225 A dedicated frame can show the TOC with the current section
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5226 always automatically highlighted. The frame is created and
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5227 deleted from the toc buffer with the @kbd{d} key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5228 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5229
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5230 @noindent @b{Version 4.19}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5231 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5232 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5233 New command `reftex-toc-recenter' (@kbd{C-c -}) which shows the current
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5234 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5235 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5236 Recentering happens automatically in idle time when the option
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5237 @code{reftex-auto-recenter-toc} is turned on.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5238 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5239 Fixed several bugs related to automatic cursor positioning in the TOC
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5240 buffer.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5241 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5242 The highlight in the TOC buffer stays when the focus moves to a
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5243 different window.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5244 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5245 New command `reftex-goto-label'.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5246 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5247 Part numbers are no longer included in chapter numbers, and a new
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5248 part does not reset the chapter counter. See new option
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5249 @code{reftex-part-resets-chapter}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5250 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5251
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5252 @noindent @b{Version 4.18}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5253 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5254 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5255 @code{reftex-citation} uses the word before the cursor as a default
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5256 search string.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5257 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5258 Simplified several regular expressions for speed.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5259 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5260 Better support for chapterbib.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5261 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5262
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5263 @noindent @b{Version 4.17}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5264 @itemize @bullet
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5265 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5266 The toc window can be split off horizontally. See new options
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5267 @code{reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5268 @code{reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally-fraction}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5269 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5270 It is possible to specify a function which verifies an index match
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5271 during global indexing. See new option @code{reftex-index-verify-function}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5272 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5273 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5274 be configured. See new option @code{reftex-include-file-commands}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5275 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5276 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography) can
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5277 be configured. See new option @code{reftex-bibliography-commands}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5278 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5279 The regular expression used to search for the \bibliography macro has
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5280 been relaxed to allow for @samp{@{\bibliography@{...@}@}} needed by
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5281 chapterbib.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5282 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5283 Small bug fixes.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5284 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5285
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5286 @noindent @b{Version 4.15}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5287 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5288 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5289 Fixed bug with parsing of BibTeX files, when fields contain quotes or
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5290 unmatched parenthesis.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5291 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5292 Small bug fixes.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5293 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5294 Improved interaction with Emacs LaTeX mode.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5295 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5296
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5297 @noindent @b{Version 4.12}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5298 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5299 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5300 Support for @file{bibentry} citation style.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5301 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5302
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5303 @noindent @b{Version 4.11}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5304 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5305 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5306 Fixed bug which would parse @samp{\Section} just like @samp{\section}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5307 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5308
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5309 @noindent @b{Version 4.10}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5310 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5311 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5312 Renamed @file{reftex-vcr.el} to @file{reftex-dcr.el} because of conflict
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5313 with @file{reftex-vars.el} on DOS machines.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5314 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5315 New options @code{reftex-parse-file-extension} and
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5316 @code{reftex-index-phrase-file-extension}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5317 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5318
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5319 @noindent [.....]
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5320 @ignore
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5321 @noindent @b{Version 4.09}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5322 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5323 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5324 New option @code{reftex-toc-max-level} to limit the depth of the toc.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5325 New key binding @kbd{t} in the @file{*toc*} buffer to change this
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5326 setting.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5327 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5328 RefTeX maintains an @file{Index Phrases} file in which phrases can be
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5329 collected. When the document is ready, RefTeX can search all
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5330 these phrases and assist indexing all matches.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5331 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5332 The variables @code{reftex-index-macros} and
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5333 @code{reftex-index-default-macro} have changed their syntax slightly.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5334 The @var{repeat} parameter has move from the latter to the former.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5335 Also calls to @code{reftex-add-index-macros} from AUCTeX style files
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5336 need to be adapted.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5337 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5338 The variable @code{reftex-section-levels} no longer contains the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5339 default stuff which has been moved to a constant.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5340 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5341 Environments like theorems can be placed into the TOC by putting
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5342 entries for @samp{"begin@{theorem@}"} in
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5343 @code{reftex-setion-levels}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5344 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5345
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5346 @noindent @b{Version 4.06}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5347 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5348 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5349 @code{reftex-section-levels} can contain a function to compute the level
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5350 of a sectioning command.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5351 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5352 Multiple @code{thebibliography} environments recognized.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5353 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5354
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5355 @noindent @b{Version 4.04}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5356 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5357 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5358 New option @code{reftex-index-default-tag} implements a default for queries.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5359 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5360
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5361 @noindent @b{Version 4.02}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5362 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5363 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5364 macros ending in @samp{refrange} are considered to contain references.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5365 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5366 Index entries made with @code{reftex-index-selection-or-word} in TeX
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5367 math mode automatically get enclosing @samp{$} to preserve math mode. See
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5368 new option @code{reftex-index-math-format}. Requires AUCTeX.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5369 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5370
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5371 @noindent @b{Version 4.01}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5372 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5373 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5374 New command @code{reftex-index-globally} to index a word in many
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5375 places in the document. Also available from the index buffer with
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5376 @kbd{&}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5377 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5378 The first item in a @code{reftex-label-alist} entry may now also be a parser
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5379 function to do non-standard parsing.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5380 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5381 @code{reftex-auto-view-crossref} no longer interferes with
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5382 @code{pop-up-frames} (patch from Stefan Monnier).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5383 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5384
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5385 @noindent @b{Version 4.00}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5386 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5387 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5388 RefTeX has been split into several smaller files which are autoloaded on
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5389 demand.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5390 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5391 Index support, along with many new options.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5392 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5393 The selection of keys for @code{\ref} and @code{\cite} now allows to
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5394 select multiple items by marking entries with the @kbd{m} key.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5395 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5396 Fancyref support.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5397 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5398
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5399 @noindent @b{Version 3.43}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5400 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5401 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5402 Viewing cross-references generalized. Now works on @code{\label},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5403 @code{\ref}, @code{\cite}, @code{\bibitem}, @code{\index}, variations of
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5404 these, and from BibTeX buffers.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5405 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5406 New option @code{reftex-view-crossref-extra}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5407 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5408 Support for the additional sectioning commands @code{\addchap} and
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5409 @code{\addsec} which are defined in the LaTeX KOMA-Script classes.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5410 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5411 Files in @code{reftex-default-bibliography} will be searched along
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5412 @code{BIBINPUTS} path.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5413 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5414 Reading a parse file now checks consistency.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5415 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5416
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5417 @noindent @b{Version 3.42}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5418 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5419 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5420 File search further refined. New option @code{reftex-file-extensions}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5421 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5422 @file{*toc*} buffer can show the file boundaries of a multifile
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5423 document, all labels and associated context. New keys @kbd{i}, @kbd{l},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5424 and @kbd{c}. New options @code{reftex-toc-include-labels},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5425 @code{reftex-toc-include-context},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5426 @code{reftex-toc-include-file-boundaries}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5427 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5428
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5429 @noindent @b{Version 3.41}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5430 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5431 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5432 New options @code{reftex-texpath-environment-variables},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5433 @code{reftex-use-external-file-finders},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5434 @code{reftex-external-file-finders},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5435 @code{reftex-search-unrecursed-path-first}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5436 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5437 @emph{kpathsearch} support. See new options and
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5438 @code{reftex-bibpath-environment-variables}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5439 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5440
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5441 @noindent @b{Version 3.38}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5442 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5443 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5444 @code{reftex-view-crossref} no longer moves to find a macro. Point has
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5445 to be on the macro argument.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5446 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5447
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5448 @noindent @b{Version 3.36}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5449 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5450 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5451 New value @code{window} for option @code{reftex-auto-view-crossref}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5452 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5453
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5454 @noindent @b{Version 3.35}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5455 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5456 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5457 ISO 8859 Latin-1 chars are converted to ASCII to derive better labels.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5458 This takes back the related changes in 3.34 for safety reasons.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5459 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5460
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5461 @noindent @b{Version 3.34}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5462 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5463 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5464 Additional flag in @code{reftex-derive-label-parameters} do make only
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5465 lowercase labels (default @code{t}).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5466 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5467 All @file{.rel} files have a final newline to avoid queries.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5468 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5469 Single byte representations of accented European letters (ISO-8859-1)
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5470 are now legal in labels.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5471 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5472
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5473 @noindent @b{Version 3.33}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5474 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5475 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5476 Multiple selection buffers are now hidden buffers (they start with a
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5477 SPACE).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5478 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5479 Fixed bug with file search when TEXINPUTS environment variable is empty.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5480 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5481
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5482 @noindent @b{Version 3.30}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5483 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5484 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5485 In @code{reftex-citation}, the regular expression used to scan BibTeX
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5486 files can be specified using completion on known citation keys.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5487 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5488 New keys @kbd{a} and @kbd{A} in BibTeX selection process to cite @emph{all}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5489 entries.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5490 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5491 New command @code{reftex-renumber-simple-labels} to renumber simple
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5492 labels like @samp{eq:13} sequentially through a document.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5493 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5494
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5495 @noindent @b{Version 3.28}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5496 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5497 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5498 Auto view crossref for XEmacs uses @code{post-command-hook} to restart the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5499 timer, since itimer restart is not reliable.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5500 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5501 Option @code{reftex-bibfile-ignore-list} renamed to @code{-regexps}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5502 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5503 Expansion of recursive tex and bib path rewritten.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5504 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5505 Fixed problem where @b{Ref@TeX{}} did not scan unsaved buffers.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5506 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5507 Fixed bug with section numbering after *-red sections.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5508 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5509
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5510 @noindent @b{Version 3.27}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5511 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5512 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5513 Macros can define @emph{neutral} labels, just like @code{\label}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5514 itself.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5515 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5516 New option @code{reftex-allow-detached-macro-args}, default @code{nil}!
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5517 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5518
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5519 @noindent @b{Version 3.26}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5520 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5521 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5522 [X]Emacs 19 no longer supported. Use 3.22 for Emacs 19.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5523 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5524 New hooks @code{reftex-translate-to-ascii-function},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5525 @code{reftex-string-to-label-function}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5526 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5527 Made sure automatic crossref display will not visit/scan files.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5528 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5529
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5530 @noindent @b{Version 3.25}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5531 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5532 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5533 Echoing of citation info caches the info for displayed entries.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5534 New option @code{reftex-cache-cite-echo}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5535 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5536 @kbd{M-x reftex-reset-mode} now also removes the file with parsing
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5537 info.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5538 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5539 Default of @code{reftex-revisit-to-follow} changed to nil.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5540 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5541
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5542 @noindent @b{Version 3.24}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5543 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5544 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5545 New option @code{reftex-revisit-to-echo}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5546 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5547 Interface with X-Symbol (>=2.6) is now complete and stable.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5548 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5549 Adapted to new outline, which uses overlays.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5550 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5551 File names in @code{\bibliography} may now have the @code{.bib}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5552 extension.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5553 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5554 Fixed Bug with parsing "single file" from master file buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5555 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5556
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5557 @noindent @b{Version 3.23}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5558 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5559 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5560 Parse files @file{MASTER.rel} made compatible between Emacs and XEmacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5561 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5562 @code{kill-emacs-hook} and @code{kill-buffer-hook} now write the parse
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5563 file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5564 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5565 The cursor inside a @code{\ref} or @code{\cite} macro can now trigger
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5566 automatic display of crossref information in the echo area. See
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5567 variable @code{reftex-auto-view-crossref}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5568 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5569 AUCTeX interface updates:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5570 @itemize @minus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5571 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5572 AUCTeX 9.9c and later notifies @b{Ref@TeX{}} about new sections.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5573 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5574 @b{Ref@TeX{}} notifies AUCTeX about new labels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5575 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5576 @code{TeX-arg-ref} no longer used (introduction was unnecessary).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5577 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5578 @code{reftex-arg-label} and @code{reftex-arg-cite} fixed up.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5579 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5580 Settings added to @b{Ref@TeX{}} via style files remain local.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5581 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5582 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5583 Fixed bug with @code{reftex-citation} in non-latex buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5584 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5585 Fixed bug with syntax table and context refontification.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5586 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5587 Safety-net for name change of @code{font-lock-reference-face}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5588 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5589
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5590 @noindent @b{Version 3.22}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5591 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5592 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5593 Fixed bug with empty context strings.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5594 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5595 @code{reftex-mouse-view-crossref} is now bound by default at
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5596 @kbd{S-mouse-2}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5597 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5598
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5599 @noindent @b{Version 3.21}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5600 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5601 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5602 New options for all faces used by @b{Ref@TeX{}}. They're in the
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5603 customization group @code{reftex-fontification-configurations}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5604 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5605
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5606 @noindent @b{Version 3.19}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5607 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5608 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5609 Fixed bug with AUCTeX @code{TeX-master}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5610 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5611
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5612 @noindent @b{Version 3.18}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5613 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5614 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5615 The selection now uses a recursive edit, much like minibuffer input.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5616 This removes all restrictions during selection. E.g. you can now
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5617 switch buffers at will, use the mouse etc.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5618 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5619 New option @code{reftex-highlight-selection}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5620 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5621 @kbd{mouse-2} can be used to select in selection and @file{*toc*}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5622 buffers.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5623 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5624 Fixed some problems regarding the interaction with VIPER mode.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5625 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5626 Follow-mode is now only used after point motion.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5627 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5628 @b{Ref@TeX{}} now finally does not fontify temporary files anymore.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5629 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5630
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5631 @noindent @b{Version 3.17}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5632 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5633 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5634 Additional bindings in selection and @file{*toc*} buffers. @kbd{g}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5635 redefined.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5636 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5637 New command @code{reftex-save-all-document-buffers}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5638 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5639 Magic word matching made more intelligent.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5640 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5641 Selection process can switch to completion (with @key{TAB}).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5642 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5643 @code{\appendix} is now recognized and influences section numbering.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5644 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5645 File commentary shortened considerably (use Info documentation).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5646 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5647 New option @code{reftex-no-include-regexps} to skip some include files.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5648 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5649 New option @code{reftex-revisit-to-follow}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5650 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5651
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5652 @noindent @b{Version 3.16}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5653 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5654 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5655 New hooks @code{reftex-format-label-function},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5656 @code{reftex-format-ref-function}, @code{reftex-format-cite-function}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5657 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5658 TeXInfo documentation completed.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5659 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5660 Some restrictions in Label inserting and referencing removed.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5661 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5662 New variable @code{reftex-default-bibliography}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5663 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5664
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5665 @noindent @b{Version 3.14}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5666 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5667 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5668 Selection buffers can be kept between selections: this is faster.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5669 See new variable @code{reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5670 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5671 Prefix interpretation of reftex-view-crossref changed.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5672 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5673 Support for the @code{varioref} package (@kbd{v} key in selection
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5674 buffer).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5675 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5676
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5677 @noindent @b{Version 3.12}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5678 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5679 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5680 There are 3 new keymaps for customization: @code{reftex-toc-map},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5681 @code{reftex-select-label-map}, @code{reftex-select-bib-map}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5682 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5683 Refontification uses more standard font-lock stuff.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5684 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5685 When no BibTeX database files are specified, citations can also use
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5686 @code{\bibitem} entries from a @code{thebibliography} environment.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5687 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5688
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5689 @noindent @b{Version 3.11}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5690 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5691 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5692 Fixed bug which led to naked label in (e.g.) footnotes.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5693 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5694 Added scroll-other-window functions to RefTeX-Select.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5695 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5696
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5697 @noindent @b{Version 3.10}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5698 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5699 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5700 Fixed a bug which made reftex 3.07 fail on [X]Emacs version 19.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5701 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5702 Removed unimportant code which caused OS/2 Emacs to crash.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5703 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5704 All customization variables now accessible from menu.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5705 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5706
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5707 @noindent @b{Version 3.07}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5708 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5709 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5710 @code{Ref} menu improved.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5711 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5712
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5713 @noindent @b{Version 3.05}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5714 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5715 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5716 Compatibility code now first checks for XEmacs feature.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5717 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5718
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5719 @noindent @b{Version 3.04}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5720 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5721 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5722 Fixed BUG in the @emph{xr} support.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5723 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5724
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5725 @noindent @b{Version 3.03}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5726 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5727 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5728 Support for the LaTeX package @code{xr}, for inter-document
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5729 references.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5730 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5731 A few (minor) Mule-related changes.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5732 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5733 Fixed bug which could cause @emph{huge} @file{.rel} files.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5734 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5735 Search for input and @file{.bib} files with recursive path definitions.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5736 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5737
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5738 @noindent @b{Version 3.00}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5739 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5740 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5741 @b{Ref@TeX{}} should work better for very large projects:
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5742 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5743 The new parser works without creating a master buffer.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5744 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5745 Rescanning can be limited to a part of a multifile document.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5746 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5747 Information from the parser can be stored in a file.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5748 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5749 @b{Ref@TeX{}} can deal with macros having a naked label as an argument.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5750 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5751 Macros may have white space and newlines between arguments.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5752 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5753 Multiple identical section headings no longer confuse
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5754 @code{reftex-toc}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5755 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5756 @b{Ref@TeX{}} should work correctly in combination with buffer-altering
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5757 packages like outline, folding, x-symbol, iso-cvt, isotex, etc.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5758 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5759 All labeled environments discussed in @emph{The LaTeX Companion} by
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5760 Goossens, Mittelbach & Samarin, Addison-Wesley 1994) are part of
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5761 @b{Ref@TeX{}}'s defaults.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5762 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5763
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5764 @noindent @b{Version 2.17}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5765 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5766 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5767 Label prefix expands % escapes with current file name and other stuff.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5768 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5769 Citation format now with % escapes. This is not backward
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5770 compatible!
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5771 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5772 TEXINPUTS variable recognized when looking for input files.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5773 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5774 Context can be the nth argument of a macro.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5775 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5776 Searching in the select buffer is now possible (@kbd{C-s} and
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5777 @kbd{C-r}).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5778 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5779 Display and derive-label can use two different context methods.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5780 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5781 AMSmath @code{xalignat} and @code{xxalignat} added.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5782 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5783
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5784 @noindent @b{Version 2.14}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5785 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5786 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5787 Variable @code{reftex-plug-into-AUCTeX} simplifies cooperation with
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5788 AUCTeX.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5789 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5790
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5791 @noindent @b{Version 2.11}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5792 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5793 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5794 Submitted for inclusion to Emacs and XEmacs.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5795 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5796
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5797 @noindent @b{Version 2.07}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5798 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5799 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5800 New functions @code{reftex-search-document},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5801 @code{reftex-query-replace-document}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5802 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5803
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5804 @noindent @b{Version 2.05}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5805 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5806 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5807 Support for @file{custom.el}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5808 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5809 New function @code{reftex-grep-document} (thanks to Stephen Eglen).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5810 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5811
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5812 @noindent @b{Version 2.03}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5813 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5814 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5815 @code{figure*}, @code{table*}, @code{sidewaysfigure/table} added to
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5816 default environments.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5817 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5818 @code{reftex-bibfile-ignore-list} introduced (thanks to Rory Molinari).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5819 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5820 New functions @code{reftex-arg-label}, @code{reftex-arg-ref},
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5821 @code{reftex-arg-cite}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5822 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5823 Emacs/XEmacs compatibility reworked. XEmacs 19.15 now is
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5824 required.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5825 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5826 @code{reftex-add-to-label-alist} (to be called from AUCTeX style
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5827 files).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5828 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5829 Finding context with a hook function.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5830 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5831 Sorting BibTeX entries (new variable:
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5832 @code{reftex-sort-bibtex-matches}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5833 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5834
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5835 @noindent @b{Version 2.00}
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
5836 @itemize @bullet
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
5837 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5838 Labels can be derived from context (default for sections).
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5839 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5840 Configuration of label insertion and label referencing revised.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5841 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5842 Crossref fields in BibTeX database entries.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5843 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5844 @code{reftex-toc} introduced (thanks to Stephen Eglen).
26911
d7f536a01276 Update to reftex 4.9
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
5845 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5846
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5847 @noindent @b{Version 1.09}
27195
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
5848 @itemize @bullet
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
5849 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5850 Support for @code{tex-main-file}, an analogue for
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5851 @code{TeX-master}.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5852 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5853 MS-DOS support.
27195
d7311a9cb223 version 4.10
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 26911
diff changeset
5854 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5855
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5856 @noindent @b{Version 1.07}
29772
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
5857 @itemize @bullet
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
5858 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5859 @b{Ref@TeX{}} gets its own menu.
29772
265fdb06f294 Update to reftex 4 14
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 29713
diff changeset
5860 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5861
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5862 @noindent @b{Version 1.05}
34403
6679ef9b33fe RefTeX 4.15 update
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 30009
diff changeset
5863 @itemize @bullet
6679ef9b33fe RefTeX 4.15 update
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 30009
diff changeset
5864 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5865 XEmacs port.
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5866 @end itemize
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5867
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5868 @noindent @b{Version 1.04}
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5869 @itemize @bullet
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5870 @item
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5871 Macros as wrappers, AMSTeX support, delayed context parsing for
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5872 new labels.
34403
6679ef9b33fe RefTeX 4.15 update
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 30009
diff changeset
5873 @end itemize
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
5874 @end ignore
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5875
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5876 @noindent @b{Version 1.00}
46684
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
5877 @itemize @bullet
9569bac241a3 Update to RefTeX 4.18
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46272
diff changeset
5878 @item
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5879 released on 7 Jan 1997.
47050
904fd28be439 Update to RefTeX 4.19
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 46918
diff changeset
5880 @end itemize
59536
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5881
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5882
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5883
bf2af98cd2b4 version 4.26
Carsten Dominik <dominik@science.uva.nl>
parents: 58872
diff changeset
5884
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5885
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5886 @node Index, , , Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5887 @unnumbered Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5888 @printindex cp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5889
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5890 @summarycontents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5891 @contents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5892 @bye
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5893